a2b162ce5b5a8ed1077110b02a322e4716ddc443
[binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @setfilename ld.info
3 @c Copyright (C) 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @syncodeindex ky cp
5 @c man begin INCLUDE
6 @include configdoc.texi
7 @c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
8 @include bfdver.texi
9 @c man end
10
11 @c @smallbook
12
13 @macro gcctabopt{body}
14 @code{\body\}
15 @end macro
16
17 @c man begin NAME
18 @ifset man
19 @c Configure for the generation of man pages
20 @set UsesEnvVars
21 @set GENERIC
22 @set ARM
23 @set C6X
24 @set CSKY
25 @set H8300
26 @set HPPA
27 @set M68HC11
28 @set M68K
29 @set MIPS
30 @set MMIX
31 @set MSP430
32 @set NDS32
33 @set NIOSII
34 @set PDP11
35 @set POWERPC
36 @set POWERPC64
37 @set Renesas
38 @set S/390
39 @set SPU
40 @set TICOFF
41 @set WIN32
42 @set XTENSA
43 @end ifset
44 @c man end
45
46 @ifnottex
47 @dircategory Software development
48 @direntry
49 * Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
50 @end direntry
51 @end ifnottex
52
53 @copying
54 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57 @end ifset
58 version @value{VERSION}.
59
60 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
61
62 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
63 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
64 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
67 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
68 @end copying
69 @iftex
70 @finalout
71 @setchapternewpage odd
72 @settitle The GNU linker
73 @titlepage
74 @title The GNU linker
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @code{ld}
77 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79 @end ifset
80 @subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81 @author Steve Chamberlain
82 @author Ian Lance Taylor
83 @page
84
85 @tex
86 {\parskip=0pt
87 \hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88 \hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
89 \hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
90 \hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91 }
92 \global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
101 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
104 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
105 @c man end
106
107 @end titlepage
108 @end iftex
109 @contents
110 @c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top
114 @top LD
115 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118 @end ifset
119 version @value{VERSION}.
120
121 This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
122 Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123 in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
124
125 @menu
126 * Overview:: Overview
127 * Invocation:: Invocation
128 * Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129 * Plugins:: Linker Plugins
130 @ifset GENERIC
131 * Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132 @end ifset
133 @ifclear GENERIC
134 @ifset H8300
135 * H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136 @end ifset
137 @ifset Renesas
138 * Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
139 @end ifset
140 @ifset ARM
141 * ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142 @end ifset
143 @ifset M68HC11
144 * M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145 @end ifset
146 @ifset HPPA
147 * HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148 @end ifset
149 @ifset M68K
150 * M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151 @end ifset
152 @ifset MIPS
153 * MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154 @end ifset
155 @ifset POWERPC
156 * PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157 @end ifset
158 @ifset POWERPC64
159 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160 @end ifset
161 @ifset S/390
162 * S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163 @end ifset
164 @ifset SPU
165 * SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166 @end ifset
167 @ifset TICOFF
168 * TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169 @end ifset
170 @ifset WIN32
171 * Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172 @end ifset
173 @ifset XTENSA
174 * Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175 @end ifset
176 @end ifclear
177 @ifclear SingleFormat
178 * BFD:: BFD
179 @end ifclear
180 @c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182 * Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183 * MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
184 * GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
185 * LD Index:: LD Index
186 @end menu
187 @end ifnottex
188
189 @node Overview
190 @chapter Overview
191
192 @cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193 @cindex what is this?
194
195 @ifset man
196 @c man begin SYNOPSIS
197 ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
198 @c man end
199
200 @c man begin SEEALSO
201 ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202 the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203 @file{ld}.
204 @c man end
205 @end ifset
206
207 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
209 @command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
210 their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
211 compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
212
213 @command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
214 a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215 to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
217 @ifset man
218 @c For the man only
219 This man page does not describe the command language; see the
220 @command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221 language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
222 @end ifset
223
224 @ifclear SingleFormat
225 This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226 to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
227 write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228 @code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229 available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230 @end ifclear
231
232 Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233 linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234 execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
235 @command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
236 (or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
238 @c man end
239
240 @node Invocation
241 @chapter Invocation
242
243 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
245 The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
246 and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247 you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
249 @c man end
250
251 @ifset UsesEnvVars
252 @menu
253 * Options:: Command-line Options
254 * Environment:: Environment Variables
255 @end menu
256
257 @node Options
258 @section Command-line Options
259 @end ifset
260
261 @cindex command line
262 @cindex options
263
264 @c man begin OPTIONS
265
266 The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267 practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268 @cindex standard Unix system
269 For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
270 object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271 link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273 @smallexample
274 ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275 @end smallexample
276
277 This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
278 result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279 the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280 directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
282 Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
283 point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284 as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285 which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286 files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287 different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
288 occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289 option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290 noted in the descriptions below.
291
292 @cindex object files
293 Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294 together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295 options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296 an option and its argument.
297
298 Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299 specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300 and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301 are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302 message @samp{No input files}.
303
304 If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
305 assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306 augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307 linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308 permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309 or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
310 @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311 script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312 extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313 to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314 the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
315
316 For options whose names are a single letter,
317 option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318 whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319 option that requires them.
320
321 For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
322 precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
323 @samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
324 this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
325 only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
326 @samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327 name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328 output.
329
330 Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331 option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332 immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333 @samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334 Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335 accepted.
336
337 Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
338 (e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
339 prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340 compiler driver) like this:
341
342 @smallexample
343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
344 @end smallexample
345
346 This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
347 silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348 may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349 driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350 a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351 and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352 the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354 @smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356 @end smallexample
357
358 Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
359 linker:
360
361 @table @gcctabopt
362 @include at-file.texi
363
364 @kindex -a @var{keyword}
365 @item -a @var{keyword}
366 This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367 argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368 @samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369 @samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370 to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
372 @kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373 @item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378 finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
379 it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
380 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
381 interface.
382
383 @ifclear SingleFormat
384 @cindex binary input format
385 @kindex -b @var{format}
386 @kindex --format=@var{format}
387 @cindex input format
388 @cindex input format
389 @item -b @var{input-format}
390 @itemx --format=@var{input-format}
391 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
393 @samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
394 that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
395 configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
396 to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
397 default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398 @var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399 supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400 formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401 @xref{BFD}.
402
403 You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404 binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405 linking object files of different formats), by including
406 @samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
407 particular format.
408
409 The default format is taken from the environment variable
410 @code{GNUTARGET}.
411 @ifset UsesEnvVars
412 @xref{Environment}.
413 @end ifset
414 You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
415 @code{TARGET};
416 @ifclear man
417 see @ref{Format Commands}.
418 @end ifclear
419 @end ifclear
420
421 @kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422 @kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423 @cindex compatibility, MRI
424 @item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425 @itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
426 For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
427 files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
428 @ifclear man
429 @ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430 @end ifclear
431 @ifset man
432 the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433 @end ifset
434 Introduce MRI script files with
435 the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
436 scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437 If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
438 specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440 @cindex common allocation
441 @kindex -d
442 @kindex -dc
443 @kindex -dp
444 @item -d
445 @itemx -dc
446 @itemx -dp
447 These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448 compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449 even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450 script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
453 @kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454 @kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455 @item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456 @itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461 option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
462 The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
463
464 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466 This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467 fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468 section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469 error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470 several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471 section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472 sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474 @smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493 @end smallexample
494
495 This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496 the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500 This option enables warnings when
501 @code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502 matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503 discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504 output region.
505
506 @cindex entry point, from command line
507 @kindex -e @var{entry}
508 @kindex --entry=@var{entry}
509 @item -e @var{entry}
510 @itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511 Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512 program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513 named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514 and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515 base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516 @samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517 and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
519 @kindex --exclude-libs
520 @item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521 Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
522 exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
523 @code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524 automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525 port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526 explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527 option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528 be treated as hidden.
529
530 @kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532 Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533 should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534 into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535 may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536 used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537 the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538 match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539 command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540 of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541 regardless of this option.
542
543 @cindex dynamic symbol table
544 @kindex -E
545 @kindex --export-dynamic
546 @kindex --no-export-dynamic
547 @item -E
548 @itemx --export-dynamic
549 @itemx --no-export-dynamic
550 When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551 option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552 all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553 set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555 If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556 @option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557 dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558 referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
559
560 If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561 back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562 dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563 linking the program itself.
564
565 You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
566 be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
567 See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
568
569 Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570 support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571 the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
573 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574 @cindex export dynamic symbol
575 @item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576 When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577 @var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578 shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579 bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580 no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581 @samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582 on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585 @cindex export dynamic symbol list
586 @item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587 Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588 The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
591 @ifclear SingleFormat
592 @cindex big-endian objects
593 @cindex endianness
594 @kindex -EB
595 @item -EB
596 Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598 @cindex little-endian objects
599 @kindex -EL
600 @item -EL
601 Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
602 @end ifclear
603
604 @kindex -f @var{name}
605 @kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606 @item -f @var{name}
607 @itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
608 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609 to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610 table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611 symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615 the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616 first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617 @var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618 in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619 Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620 implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
621 machine-specific performance.
622
623 This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624 will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
626 @kindex -F @var{name}
627 @kindex --filter=@var{name}
628 @item -F @var{name}
629 @itemx --filter=@var{name}
630 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631 the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632 of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633 on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637 dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638 filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639 found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640 used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641 @var{name}.
642
643 Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
644 toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
645 object files.
646 @ifclear SingleFormat
647 The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
648 @option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
649 @code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
650 environment variable.
651 @end ifclear
652 The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653 creating an ELF shared object.
654
655 @cindex finalization function
656 @kindex -fini=@var{name}
657 @item -fini=@var{name}
658 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659 executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660 address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661 the function to call.
662
663 @kindex -g
664 @item -g
665 Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
667 @kindex -G @var{value}
668 @kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
669 @cindex object size
670 @item -G @var{value}
671 @itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672 Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673 @var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
674 MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
675 sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677 @cindex runtime library name
678 @kindex -h @var{name}
679 @kindex -soname=@var{name}
680 @item -h @var{name}
681 @itemx -soname=@var{name}
682 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683 the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684 which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685 linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686 field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
687
688 @kindex -i
689 @cindex incremental link
690 @item -i
691 Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
693 @cindex initialization function
694 @kindex -init=@var{name}
695 @item -init=@var{name}
696 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697 executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698 of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699 function to call.
700
701 @cindex archive files, from cmd line
702 @kindex -l @var{namespec}
703 @kindex --library=@var{namespec}
704 @item -l @var{namespec}
705 @itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706 Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707 list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708 If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
709 will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
710 will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
711
712 On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
713 files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714 and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715 called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716 @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717 indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718 to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719 @var{filename}.
720
721 The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722 specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723 was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724 command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725 archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726 the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
728 See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
729 archives multiple times.
730
731 You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733 @ifset GENERIC
734 This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
735 if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
736 behaviour of the AIX linker.
737 @end ifset
738
739 @cindex search directory, from cmd line
740 @kindex -L @var{dir}
741 @kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
742 @item -L @var{searchdir}
743 @itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
744 Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745 for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
746 option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747 in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748 on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
749 @option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
750 order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751 how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752 option is specified.
753
754 If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755 prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756 @samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
757
758 @ifset UsesEnvVars
759 The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
760 @samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
761 some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762 @end ifset
763
764 The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765 @code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766 at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768 @cindex emulation
769 @kindex -m @var{emulation}
770 @item -m @var{emulation}
771 Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772 emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774 If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775 @code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777 Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778 configured.
779
780 @cindex link map
781 @kindex -M
782 @kindex --print-map
783 @item -M
784 @itemx --print-map
785 Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786 information about the link, including the following:
787
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 Where object files are mapped into memory.
791 @item
792 How common symbols are allocated.
793 @item
794 All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795 which caused the archive member to be brought in.
796 @item
797 The values assigned to symbols.
798
799 Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800 involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801 have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802 linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803 of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804 the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805 linker script containing:
806
807 @smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811 @end smallexample
812
813 will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814 option is used:
815
816 @smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820 @end smallexample
821
822 See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823 scripts.
824
825 @item
826 How GNU properties are merged.
827
828 When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829 .note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830 These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
831
832 @smallexample
833 Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834 @end smallexample
835
836 This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
837 merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840 @smallexample
841 Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
842 @end smallexample
843
844 This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
845 when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
847 @end itemize
848
849 @cindex link map discarded
850 @kindex --print-map-discarded
851 @kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852 @item --print-map-discarded
853 @itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854 Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855 in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
857 @kindex -n
858 @cindex read-only text
859 @cindex NMAGIC
860 @kindex --nmagic
861 @item -n
862 @itemx --nmagic
863 Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865 mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
866
867 @kindex -N
868 @kindex --omagic
869 @cindex read/write from cmd line
870 @cindex OMAGIC
871 @item -N
872 @itemx --omagic
873 Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
874 not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
876 mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877 is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878 specification published by Microsoft.
879
880 @kindex --no-omagic
881 @cindex OMAGIC
882 @item --no-omagic
883 This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884 sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885 be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886 shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
887
888 @kindex -o @var{output}
889 @kindex --output=@var{output}
890 @cindex naming the output file
891 @item -o @var{output}
892 @itemx --output=@var{output}
893 Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
894 option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895 script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
897 @kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898 @cindex dependency file
899 @item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900 Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901 suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902 that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903 output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904 Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905 Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906 to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907 linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908 @samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909 installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910 distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
912 @kindex -O @var{level}
913 @cindex generating optimized output
914 @item -O @var{level}
915 If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
916 the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
917 should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918 option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919 the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920 no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921 of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
922
923 @kindex -plugin @var{name}
924 @item -plugin @var{name}
925 Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926 the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927 automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928 optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929 wish.
930
931 Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932 from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933 @command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934 those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
935 copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
936 based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
937 just copy in the newest one.
938
939 @kindex --push-state
940 @cindex push state governing input file handling
941 @item --push-state
942 The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
943 flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944 restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946 The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947 @option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948 @option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949 @option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950 @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951 @option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953 One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954 used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955 listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956 something as follows:
957
958 @smallexample
959 -Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960 @end smallexample
961
962 @kindex --pop-state
963 @cindex pop state governing input file handling
964 @item --pop-state
965 Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966 flags governing input file handling.
967
968 @kindex -q
969 @kindex --emit-relocs
970 @cindex retain relocations in final executable
971 @item -q
972 @itemx --emit-relocs
973 Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
974 Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975 order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976 in larger executables.
977
978 This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
980 @kindex --force-dynamic
981 @cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982 @item --force-dynamic
983 Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984 to VxWorks targets.
985
986 @cindex partial link
987 @cindex relocatable output
988 @kindex -r
989 @kindex --relocatable
990 @item -r
991 @itemx --relocatable
992 Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
993 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
994 linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995 magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996 @code{OMAGIC}.
997 @c ; see @option{-N}.
998 If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999 linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000 constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
1002 When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003 partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004 relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005 example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006 with input files in other formats at all.
1007
1008 This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010 @kindex -R @var{file}
1011 @kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012 @cindex symbol-only input
1013 @item -R @var{filename}
1014 @itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015 Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016 relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017 to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018 programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
1020 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
1021 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
1022 the @option{-rpath} option.
1023
1024 @kindex -s
1025 @kindex --strip-all
1026 @cindex strip all symbols
1027 @item -s
1028 @itemx --strip-all
1029 Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031 @kindex -S
1032 @kindex --strip-debug
1033 @cindex strip debugger symbols
1034 @item -S
1035 @itemx --strip-debug
1036 Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
1038 @kindex --strip-discarded
1039 @kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040 @item --strip-discarded
1041 @itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042 Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043 Enabled by default.
1044
1045 @kindex -t
1046 @kindex --trace
1047 @cindex input files, displaying
1048 @item -t
1049 @itemx --trace
1050 Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051 @samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052 @samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053 and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054 a linker bug report.
1055
1056 @kindex -T @var{script}
1057 @kindex --script=@var{script}
1058 @cindex script files
1059 @item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060 @itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061 Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
1062 @command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
1063 @var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
1064 output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065 the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066 specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067 options accumulate.
1068
1069 @kindex -dT @var{script}
1070 @kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071 @cindex script files
1072 @item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073 @itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074 Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076 This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077 processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078 command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079 @option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080 behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081 command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082 the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083 @samp{gcc}).
1084
1085 @kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086 @kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087 @cindex undefined symbol
1088 @item -u @var{symbol}
1089 @itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092 modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093 different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094 option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
1096 If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097 into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098 undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099 instead.
1100
1101 @kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102 @cindex symbols, require defined
1103 @cindex defined symbol
1104 @item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105 Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106 is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107 is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108 and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109 @code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110 can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
1112 @kindex -Ur
1113 @cindex constructors
1114 @item -Ur
1115 For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116 @samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
1117 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
1118 @emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119 It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120 with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121 be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122 @samp{-r} for the others.
1123
1124 @kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125 @cindex orphan sections
1126 @cindex sections, orphan
1127 @item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128 Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129 specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131 @var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133 @table @code
1134 @item place
1135 Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136 the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
1137 @samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
1138
1139 @item discard
1140 All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141 @samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143 @item warn
1144 The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145 issue a warning.
1146
1147 @item error
1148 The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149 @end table
1150
1151 The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
1153 @kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154 @item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155 Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156 @var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157 missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158 specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159 multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160 input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161 in a linker script.
1162
1163 @kindex -v
1164 @kindex -V
1165 @kindex --version
1166 @cindex version
1167 @item -v
1168 @itemx --version
1169 @itemx -V
1170 Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
1171 lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173 @kindex -x
1174 @kindex --discard-all
1175 @cindex deleting local symbols
1176 @item -x
1177 @itemx --discard-all
1178 Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180 @kindex -X
1181 @kindex --discard-locals
1182 @cindex local symbols, deleting
1183 @item -X
1184 @itemx --discard-locals
1185 Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186 system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187 or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
1188
1189 @kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190 @kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191 @cindex symbol tracing
1192 @item -y @var{symbol}
1193 @itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194 Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195 option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196 to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198 This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199 don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201 @kindex -Y @var{path}
1202 @item -Y @var{path}
1203 Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204 for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206 @kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207 @item -z @var{keyword}
1208 The recognized keywords are:
1209 @table @samp
1210
1211 @item bndplt
1212 Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214 @item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215 @itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216 @itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217 @itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218 Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219 to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220 @option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221 @option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222 @option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223 @option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224 Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
1226 @item cet-report=none
1227 @itemx cet-report=warning
1228 @itemx cet-report=error
1229 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231 section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233 @option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234 missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236 Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238 turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
1241 @item combreloc
1242 @itemx nocombreloc
1243 Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244 dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
1245
1246 @item common
1247 @itemx nocommon
1248 Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249 link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251 @item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252 Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253 layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254 using pages of this size.
1255
1256 @item defs
1257 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
1260
1261 @item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262 @itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263 Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264 if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265 by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266 @samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267 may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268 selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269 these options.
1270
1271 @item execstack
1272 Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
1274 @item global
1275 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276 the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277 of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
1279 @item globalaudit
1280 This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281 This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282 setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283 tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
1284 the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
1285 all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
1286
1287 @item ibtplt
1288 Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
1291 @item ibt
1292 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293 to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
1296 @item indirect-extern-access
1297 @itemx noindirect-extern-access
1298 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1299 .note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1300 canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1301 This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1302 @option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1303
1304 @option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1305 GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1306 section.
1307
1308 @item initfirst
1309 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1310 It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1311 before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1312 the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1313 the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1314 objects.
1315
1316 @item interpose
1317 Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1318 so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1319 libraries not so marked.
1320
1321 @item unique
1322 @itemx nounique
1323 When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1324 object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1325 and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1326 primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1327 al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1328 of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1329 and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1330
1331 @item lam-u48
1332 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1333 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1334
1335 @item lam-u57
1336 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1337 to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339 @item lam-u48-report=none
1340 @itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1341 @itemx lam-u48-report=error
1342 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1343 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344 @option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346 @option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1348 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351 @item lam-u57-report=none
1352 @itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1353 @itemx lam-u57-report=error
1354 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1355 property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1356 @option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358 @option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1360 make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
1363 @item lam-report=none
1364 @itemx lam-report=warning
1365 @itemx lam-report=error
1366 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1367 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1368 section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1369 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1370 @option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1371 missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1372 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1373 Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1374
1375 @item lazy
1376 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1377 dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1378 the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1379 Lazy binding is the default.
1380
1381 @item loadfltr
1382 Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
1383
1384 @item max-page-size=@var{value}
1385 Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
1386
1387 @item muldefs
1388 Allow multiple definitions.
1389
1390 @item nocopyreloc
1391 Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1392 defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
1393
1394 @item nodefaultlib
1395 Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1396 should ignore any default library search paths.
1397
1398 @item nodelete
1399 Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
1400
1401 @item nodlopen
1402 Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
1403
1404 @item nodump
1405 Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
1406
1407 @item noexecstack
1408 Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1409
1410 @item noextern-protected-data
1411 Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1412 library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1413 used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1414 generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1415 module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1416 i386 and x86-64.
1417
1418 @item noreloc-overflow
1419 Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1420 relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1421 overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
1422
1423 @item now
1424 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1425 dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
1426 when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1427 function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1428 called.
1429
1430 @item origin
1431 Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
1432
1433 @item pack-relative-relocs
1434 @itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1435 Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1436 and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1437 @code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1438 building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1439 @option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
1440 relative relocation. When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1441 GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1442 added to the output. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1443
1444 @item relro
1445 @itemx norelro
1446 Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1447 specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1448 relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1449 than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
1450 Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
1451
1452 @item report-relative-reloc
1453 Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1454 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1455
1456 @item separate-code
1457 @itemx noseparate-code
1458 Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1459 specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1460 be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1461 code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1462
1463 @item shstk
1464 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1465 to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1466 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1467
1468 @item stack-size=@var{value}
1469 Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
1470 Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1471 @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1472
1473 @item start-stop-gc
1474 @itemx nostart-stop-gc
1475 @cindex start-stop-gc
1476 When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1477 section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1478 input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1479 @code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1480 @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1481 linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1482 sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1483 were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1484 definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1485 object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1486 linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1487 @code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1488 treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1489
1490 @item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1491 @cindex visibility
1492 @cindex ELF symbol visibility
1493 Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1494 @code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1495 Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1496 @samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1497 start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1498 compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1499 recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1500 programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1501 between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1502
1503 @item text
1504 @itemx notext
1505 @itemx textoff
1506 Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1507 or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1508 report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
1509
1510 @item undefs
1511 Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1512 either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1513 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1514
1515 @item unique-symbol
1516 @itemx nounique-symbol
1517 Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1518 ".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1519 is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1520
1521 @item x86-64-baseline
1522 @item x86-64-v2
1523 @item x86-64-v3
1524 @itemx x86-64-v4
1525 Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
1526 @option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
1527 @option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1528 @option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1529 @option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1530 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1531
1532 @end table
1533
1534 Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
1535
1536 @kindex -(
1537 @cindex groups of archives
1538 @item -( @var{archives} -)
1539 @itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1540 The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1541 either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1542
1543 The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1544 references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1545 the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1546 archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1547 object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1548 would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
1549 they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
1550 resolved.
1551
1552 Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1553 it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1554 more archives.
1555
1556 @kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1557 @kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1558 @item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1559 @itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1560 Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
1561 recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
1562 and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1563 the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1564 behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1565 so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1566 restore the old behaviour.
1567
1568 @kindex --as-needed
1569 @kindex --no-as-needed
1570 @item --as-needed
1571 @itemx --no-as-needed
1572 This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
1573 on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
1574 the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1575 on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
1576 needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
1577 emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1578 non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1579 the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1580 non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
1581 Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1582 the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1583 needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1584 from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
1585
1586 Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1587 an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1588 @option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1589 @option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1590
1591 @kindex --add-needed
1592 @kindex --no-add-needed
1593 @item --add-needed
1594 @itemx --no-add-needed
1595 These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1596 their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1597 options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1598 and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1599
1600 @kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1601 @item -assert @var{keyword}
1602 This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1603
1604 @kindex -Bdynamic
1605 @kindex -dy
1606 @kindex -call_shared
1607 @item -Bdynamic
1608 @itemx -dy
1609 @itemx -call_shared
1610 Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1611 for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1612 default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1613 for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1614 multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
1615 @option{-l} options which follow it.
1616
1617 @kindex -Bgroup
1618 @item -Bgroup
1619 Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1620 section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1621 object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
1622 @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1623 only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
1624
1625 @kindex -Bstatic
1626 @kindex -dn
1627 @kindex -non_shared
1628 @kindex -static
1629 @item -Bstatic
1630 @itemx -dn
1631 @itemx -non_shared
1632 @itemx -static
1633 Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1634 platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1635 variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1636 may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
1637 library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
1638 option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1639 option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1640 shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1641 references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
1642 libraries.
1643
1644 @kindex -Bsymbolic
1645 @item -Bsymbolic
1646 When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1647 definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1648 for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1649 within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1650 platforms which support shared libraries.
1651
1652 @kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1653 @item -Bsymbolic-functions
1654 When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
1655 symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
1656 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1657 libraries.
1658
1659 @kindex -Bno-symbolic
1660 @item -Bno-symbolic
1661 This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1662 @samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1663
1664 @kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1665 @item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1666 Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1667 typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1668 global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1669 within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1670 to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1671 in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1672 which support shared libraries.
1673
1674 The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1675 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1676
1677 @kindex --dynamic-list-data
1678 @item --dynamic-list-data
1679 Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1680
1681 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1682 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1683 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1684 is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1685
1686 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1687 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1688 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1689
1690 @kindex --check-sections
1691 @kindex --no-check-sections
1692 @item --check-sections
1693 @itemx --no-check-sections
1694 Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
1695 been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
1696 perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1697 suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1698 allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
1699 restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
1700 Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1701 force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1702 option.
1703
1704 @kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1705 @kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1706 @item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1707 @itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1708 This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
1709 by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
1710 command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
1711 output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
1712 input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1713 specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
1714 follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1715 behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1716
1717 This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
1718 libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1719 mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1720 their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1721 required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1722 the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1723 dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
1724 symbols.
1725
1726 @cindex cross reference table
1727 @kindex --cref
1728 @item --cref
1729 Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1730 generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1731 Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1732
1733 The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1734 easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1735 sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1736 symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
1737 definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1738 where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1739 symbol are listed.
1740
1741 @cindex ctf variables
1742 @kindex --ctf-variables
1743 @kindex --no-ctf-variables
1744 @item --ctf-variables
1745 @item --no-ctf-variables
1746 The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1747 types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1748 table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1749 conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1750 usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1751 @option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1752 The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1753
1754 @cindex ctf type sharing
1755 @kindex --ctf-share-types
1756 @item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1757 Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1758
1759 @table @samp
1760 @item share-unconflicted
1761 Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1762 where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1763 translation unit. This is the default.
1764
1765 @item share-duplicated
1766 Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1767 dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1768 dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1769 always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1770 larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1771 large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1772 consumer at runtime.
1773 @end table
1774
1775 @cindex common allocation
1776 @kindex --no-define-common
1777 @item --no-define-common
1778 This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1779 The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1780 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1781
1782 The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1783 the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1784 of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1785 forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1786 Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1787 from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1788 This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1789 and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1790 duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1791 paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1792
1793 @cindex group allocation in linker script
1794 @cindex section groups
1795 @cindex COMDAT
1796 @kindex --force-group-allocation
1797 @item --force-group-allocation
1798 This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1799 normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1800 default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1801 change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1802 command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1803 effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1804
1805 @cindex symbols, from command line
1806 @kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1807 @item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
1808 Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1809 address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1810 times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1811 limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1812 context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1813 symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1814 constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
1815 using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1816 @emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1817 equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
1818
1819 The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1820 in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1821 symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1822 placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1823 the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1824 consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1825 @samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1826 you are trying to achieve.
1827
1828 @cindex demangling, from command line
1829 @kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
1830 @kindex --no-demangle
1831 @item --demangle[=@var{style}]
1832 @itemx --no-demangle
1833 These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1834 and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1835 present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1836 underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
1837 mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1838 different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1839 to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
1840 demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1841 is set. These options may be used to override the default.
1842
1843 @cindex dynamic linker, from command line
1844 @kindex -I@var{file}
1845 @kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1846 @item -I@var{file}
1847 @itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1848 Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1849 generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1850 linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1851 doing.
1852
1853 @kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1854 @item --no-dynamic-linker
1855 When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1856 linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1857 executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1858 entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1859
1860 @kindex --embedded-relocs
1861 @item --embedded-relocs
1862 This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
1863 that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
1864 is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1865 targets.
1866
1867 @kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1868 @item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1869 Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1870 in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1871
1872 @kindex --fatal-warnings
1873 @kindex --no-fatal-warnings
1874 @item --fatal-warnings
1875 @itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1876 Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1877 with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
1878
1879 @kindex --force-exe-suffix
1880 @item --force-exe-suffix
1881 Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1882
1883 If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1884 @code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1885 the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1886 option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1887 Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1888 it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1889
1890 @kindex --gc-sections
1891 @kindex --no-gc-sections
1892 @cindex garbage collection
1893 @item --gc-sections
1894 @itemx --no-gc-sections
1895 Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
1896 targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
1897 performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
1898 @samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1899 collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1900 implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
1901
1902 @samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1903 examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1904 symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1905 command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1906 referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1907 libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1908 referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1909 the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
1910 relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1911 @samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
1912
1913 This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
1914 @samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
1915 specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1916 @samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1917 command in the linker script.
1918
1919 As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1920 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1921
1922 @kindex --print-gc-sections
1923 @kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1924 @cindex garbage collection
1925 @item --print-gc-sections
1926 @itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1927 List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1928 printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1929 collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1930 default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1931 be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1932 line.
1933
1934 @kindex --gc-keep-exported
1935 @cindex garbage collection
1936 @item --gc-keep-exported
1937 When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1938 collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1939 default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1940 executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1941 collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1942 Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1943 it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1944 ELF format targets.
1945
1946 @kindex --print-output-format
1947 @cindex output format
1948 @item --print-output-format
1949 Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1950 other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1951 in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1952
1953 @kindex --print-memory-usage
1954 @cindex memory usage
1955 @item --print-memory-usage
1956 Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1957 the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1958 quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1959 headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1960 parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1961
1962 @smallexample
1963 Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1964 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1965 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1966 @end smallexample
1967
1968 @cindex help
1969 @cindex usage
1970 @kindex --help
1971 @item --help
1972 Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1973
1974 @kindex --target-help
1975 @item --target-help
1976 Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
1977
1978 @kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1979 @item -Map=@var{mapfile}
1980 Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
1981 @option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1982 @code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1983
1984 Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1985 written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1986 inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1987 file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1988 @code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1989 output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1990 @var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1991
1992 @smallexample
1993 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1994 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1995 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1996 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1997 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1998 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1999 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2000 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2001 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2002 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2003 @end smallexample
2004
2005 It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2006
2007 If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2008 operation.
2009
2010 @cindex memory usage
2011 @kindex --no-keep-memory
2012 @item --no-keep-memory
2013 @command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2014 symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
2015 instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
2016 necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
2017 while linking a large executable.
2018
2019 @kindex --no-undefined
2020 @kindex -z defs
2021 @kindex -z undefs
2022 @item --no-undefined
2023 @itemx -z defs
2024 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2025 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2026 The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2027 behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
2028 libraries being linked in.
2029
2030 The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2031
2032 @kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2033 @kindex -z muldefs
2034 @item --allow-multiple-definition
2035 @itemx -z muldefs
2036 Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2037 report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2038 first definition will be used.
2039
2040 @kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
2041 @kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2042 @item --allow-shlib-undefined
2043 @itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
2044 Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
2045 This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2046 determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2047 shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2048 how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2049
2050 The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2051 referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2052 an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2053 a shared library.
2054
2055 The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2056 libraries specified at link time are that:
2057
2058 @itemize @bullet
2059 @item
2060 A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2061 that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2062 resolvable at load time.
2063 @item
2064 There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2065 symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2066
2067 The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2068 select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2069 architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2070 appropriate memset function.
2071 @end itemize
2072
2073 @kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2074 @item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2075 If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2076 @var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2077 only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2078 libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
2079 ``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2080 undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2081 will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
2082 might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2083 error message will be displayed.
2084
2085 The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2086 switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2087
2088 @kindex --no-undefined-version
2089 @item --no-undefined-version
2090 Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2091 it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2092 will be issued instead.
2093
2094 @kindex --default-symver
2095 @item --default-symver
2096 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2097 exported symbols.
2098
2099 @kindex --default-imported-symver
2100 @item --default-imported-symver
2101 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2102 imported symbols.
2103
2104 @kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2105 @item --no-warn-mismatch
2106 Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
2107 files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2108 been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
2109 This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
2110 errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2111 have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2112 inappropriate.
2113
2114 @kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2115 @item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2116 Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2117 library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2118
2119 @kindex --no-whole-archive
2120 @item --no-whole-archive
2121 Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
2122 archive files.
2123
2124 @cindex output file after errors
2125 @kindex --noinhibit-exec
2126 @item --noinhibit-exec
2127 Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2128 Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2129 errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2130 when it issues any error whatsoever.
2131
2132 @kindex -nostdlib
2133 @item -nostdlib
2134 Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2135 command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2136 (including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2137
2138 @ifclear SingleFormat
2139 @kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2140 @item --oformat=@var{output-format}
2141 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2142 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
2143 @samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
2144 object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2145 object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
2146 should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2147 usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2148 name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2149 list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2150 command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2151 this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2152 @end ifclear
2153
2154 @kindex --out-implib
2155 @item --out-implib @var{file}
2156 Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2157 the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2158 library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2159 may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2160 behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2161 step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2162 the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2163
2164 @kindex -pie
2165 @kindex --pic-executable
2166 @item -pie
2167 @itemx --pic-executable
2168 @cindex position independent executables
2169 Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2170 ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2171 libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
2172 address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
2173 normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2174 defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2175
2176 @kindex -no-pie
2177 @item -no-pie
2178 @cindex position dependent executables
2179 Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2180
2181 @kindex -qmagic
2182 @item -qmagic
2183 This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2184
2185 @kindex -Qy
2186 @item -Qy
2187 This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2188
2189 @kindex --relax
2190 @cindex synthesizing linker
2191 @cindex relaxing addressing modes
2192 @cindex --no-relax
2193 @item --relax
2194 @itemx --no-relax
2195 An option with machine dependent effects.
2196 @ifset GENERIC
2197 This option is only supported on a few targets.
2198 @end ifset
2199 @ifset H8300
2200 @xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
2201 @end ifset
2202 @ifset XTENSA
2203 @xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2204 @end ifset
2205 @ifset M68HC11
2206 @xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2207 @end ifset
2208 @ifset NIOSII
2209 @xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2210 @end ifset
2211 @ifset POWERPC
2212 @xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2213 @end ifset
2214
2215 On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
2216 global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2217 addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2218 synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
2219 instructions, and combining constant values.
2220
2221 On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2222 debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2223 @ifset GENERIC
2224 This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2225 family of processors.
2226 @end ifset
2227
2228 On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2229 @option{--no-relax} will disable it.
2230
2231 On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2232 and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2233
2234 @cindex retaining specified symbols
2235 @cindex stripping all but some symbols
2236 @cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2237 @kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2238 @item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2239 Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2240 discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2241 symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2242 @ifset GENERIC
2243 (such as VxWorks)
2244 @end ifset
2245 where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2246 run-time memory.
2247
2248 @samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2249 or symbols needed for relocations.
2250
2251 You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2252 line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2253
2254 @ifset GENERIC
2255 @item -rpath=@var{dir}
2256 @cindex runtime library search path
2257 @kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
2258 Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
2259 linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
2260 arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
2261 them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2262
2263 The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2264 are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2265 description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2266 in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2267 have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2268
2269 If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2270 contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2271 is defined.
2272
2273 The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
2274 SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
2275 @option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2276 runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2277 options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2278 gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
2279 file systems.
2280
2281 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
2282 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
2283 the @option{-rpath} option.
2284 @end ifset
2285
2286 @ifset GENERIC
2287 @cindex link-time runtime library search path
2288 @kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2289 @item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2290 When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2291 happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2292 of the input files.
2293
2294 When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2295 non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2296 shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
2297 explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
2298 specifies the first set of directories to search. The
2299 @option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
2300 either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2301 appearing multiple times.
2302
2303 The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2304 directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2305 containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2306 and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
2307 64-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2308
2309 The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2310 @var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2311 supported.
2312
2313 This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2314 that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2315 is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2316 runtime linker would do.
2317
2318 The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
2319 libraries:
2320
2321 @enumerate
2322 @item
2323 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
2324 @item
2325 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2326 between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2327 specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2328 used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
2329 at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2330 by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2331 the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2332 @item
2333 On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2334 @option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2335 environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
2336 @item
2337 On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2338 directories specified using @option{-L} options.
2339 @item
2340 For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
2341 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
2342 @item
2343 For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2344 @code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2345 libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2346 @code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2347 @item
2348 For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2349 exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2350 to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2351 defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2352 configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2353 @item
2354 For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2355 the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2356 header file.
2357 @item
2358 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2359 linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2360 by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2361 @item
2362 The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2363 @item
2364 Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2365 @item
2366 Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2367 linker script.
2368 @end enumerate
2369
2370 Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2371 the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2372 is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2373 library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2374 @emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2375 directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2376 this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2377 @file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2378 of the first.
2379
2380 If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2381 warning and continue with the link.
2382
2383 @end ifset
2384
2385 @kindex -shared
2386 @kindex -Bshareable
2387 @item -shared
2388 @itemx -Bshareable
2389 @cindex shared libraries
2390 Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2391 and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
2392 shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
2393 undefined symbols in the link.
2394
2395 @kindex --sort-common
2396 @item --sort-common
2397 @itemx --sort-common=ascending
2398 @itemx --sort-common=descending
2399 This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2400 ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2401 sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2402 eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2403 between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2404 specified, then descending order is assumed.
2405
2406 @kindex --sort-section=name
2407 @item --sort-section=name
2408 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2409 patterns in the linker script.
2410
2411 @kindex --sort-section=alignment
2412 @item --sort-section=alignment
2413 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2414 patterns in the linker script.
2415
2416 @kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2417 @item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2418 This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2419 .dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2420 post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2421
2422 @kindex --split-by-file
2423 @item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
2424 Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
2425 each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2426 size of 1 if not given.
2427
2428 @kindex --split-by-reloc
2429 @item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
2430 Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
2431 output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
2432 This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
2433 certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2434 cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2435 that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2436 support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2437 input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2438 more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
2439 many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
2440
2441 @kindex --stats
2442 @item --stats
2443 Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2444 as execution time and memory usage.
2445
2446 @kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
2447 @item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2448 Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2449 configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2450 that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2451
2452 @kindex --task-link
2453 @item --task-link
2454 This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2455 file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2456
2457 @kindex --traditional-format
2458 @cindex traditional format
2459 @item --traditional-format
2460 For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2461 the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
2462 use the traditional format instead.
2463
2464 @cindex dbx
2465 For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
2466 symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2467 full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2468 @code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
2469 trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
2470 combine duplicate entries.
2471
2472 @kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2473 @item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2474 Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2475 address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2476 times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2477 line.
2478 @var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2479 for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2480 @samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2481 should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2482 sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2483
2484 @kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2485 @kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2486 @kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
2487 @cindex segment origins, cmd line
2488 @item -Tbss=@var{org}
2489 @itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2490 @itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2491 Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
2492 @code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
2493
2494 @kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2495 @item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2496 @cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2497 When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2498 byte of the text segment.
2499
2500 @kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2501 @item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2502 @cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2503 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2504 the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2505 text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2506
2507 @kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2508 @item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2509 @cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2510 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2511 model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2512
2513 @kindex --unresolved-symbols
2514 @item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2515 Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2516 values for @samp{method}:
2517
2518 @table @samp
2519 @item ignore-all
2520 Do not report any unresolved symbols.
2521
2522 @item report-all
2523 Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
2524
2525 @item ignore-in-object-files
2526 Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2527 ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2528
2529 @item ignore-in-shared-libs
2530 Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2531 ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2532 when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2533 libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2534 command line.
2535 @end table
2536
2537 The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2538 by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2539
2540 Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2541 unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2542 can change this to a warning.
2543
2544 @kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2545 @cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2546 @item --dll-verbose
2547 @itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2548 Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
2549 supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
2550 the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2551 argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
2552
2553 @kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2554 @cindex version script, symbol versions
2555 @item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2556 Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2557 used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
2558 about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
2559 is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2560 see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2561 use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2562 symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2563 @xref{WIN32}.
2564
2565 @kindex --warn-common
2566 @cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2567 @cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2568 @item --warn-common
2569 Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
2570 a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
2571 but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2572 you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
2573 Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
2574 warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2575
2576 There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2577
2578 @table @samp
2579 @item int i = 1;
2580 A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2581 file.
2582
2583 @item extern int i;
2584 An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2585 There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2586 variable somewhere.
2587
2588 @item int i;
2589 A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2590 variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2591 The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2592 single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2593 size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2594 a definition of the same variable.
2595 @end table
2596
2597 The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2598 Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2599 just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2600 encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2601 a common symbol.
2602
2603 @enumerate
2604 @item
2605 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2606 definition for the symbol.
2607 @smallexample
2608 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2609 overridden by definition
2610 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2611 @end smallexample
2612
2613 @item
2614 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2615 the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2616 except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2617 @smallexample
2618 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2619 overriding common
2620 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2621 @end smallexample
2622
2623 @item
2624 Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2625 @smallexample
2626 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2627 of `@var{symbol}'
2628 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2629 @end smallexample
2630
2631 @item
2632 Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2633 @smallexample
2634 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2635 overridden by larger common
2636 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2637 @end smallexample
2638
2639 @item
2640 Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2641 the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2642 encountered in a different order.
2643 @smallexample
2644 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2645 overriding smaller common
2646 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2647 @end smallexample
2648 @end enumerate
2649
2650 @kindex --warn-constructors
2651 @item --warn-constructors
2652 Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2653 object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2654 detect the use of global constructors.
2655
2656 @kindex --warn-execstack
2657 @cindex warnings, on executable stack
2658 @cindex executable stack, warnings on
2659 @item --warn-execstack
2660 @itemx --no-warn-execstack
2661 On ELF platforms this option controls how the linker generates warning
2662 messages when it creates an output file with an executable stack. By
2663 default the linker will not warn if the @command{-z execstack} command
2664 line option has been used, but this behaviour can be overridden by the
2665 @option{--warn-execstack} option.
2666
2667 On the other hand the linker will normally warn if the stack is made
2668 executable because one or more of the input files need an execuable
2669 stack and neither of the @command{-z execstack} or @command{-z
2670 noexecstack} command line options have been specified. This warning
2671 can be disabled via the @command{--no-warn-execstack} option.
2672
2673 Note: ELF format input files specify that they need an executable
2674 stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable
2675 bit set in its section flags. They can specify that they do not need
2676 an executable stack by having that section, but without the executable
2677 flag bit set. If an input file does not have a @var{.note.GNU-stack}
2678 section present then the default behaviour is target specific. For
2679 some targets, then absence of such a section implies that an
2680 executable stack @emph{is} required. This is often a problem for hand
2681 crafted assembler files.
2682
2683 @kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2684 @item --warn-multiple-gp
2685 Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2686 This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2687 Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2688 section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2689 of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2690 base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2691 base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2692 bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2693 large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2694 values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2695 option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2696
2697 @kindex --warn-once
2698 @cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2699 @cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2700 @item --warn-once
2701 Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2702 which refers to it.
2703
2704 @kindex --warn-rwx-segments
2705 @cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments
2706 @cindex executable segments, warnings on
2707 @item --warn-rwx-segments
2708 @itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments
2709 Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has
2710 all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set. Such a
2711 segment represents a potential security vulnerability. In addition
2712 warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is
2713 created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or
2714 not it has the read and/or write flags set.
2715
2716 These warnings are enabled by default. They can be disabled via the
2717 @option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the
2718 @option{--warn-rwx-segments} option.
2719
2720 @kindex --warn-section-align
2721 @cindex warnings, on section alignment
2722 @cindex section alignment, warnings on
2723 @item --warn-section-align
2724 Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2725 alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2726 The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2727 is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2728 the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2729
2730 @kindex --warn-textrel
2731 @item --warn-textrel
2732 Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2733 or shared object.
2734
2735 @kindex --warn-alternate-em
2736 @item --warn-alternate-em
2737 Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2738
2739 @kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2740 @item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2741 If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2742 @option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2743 This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2744
2745 @kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2746 @item --error-unresolved-symbols
2747 This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2748 it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2749
2750 @kindex --whole-archive
2751 @cindex including an entire archive
2752 @item --whole-archive
2753 For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
2754 @option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
2755 in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2756 files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2757 library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2758 library. This option may be used more than once.
2759
2760 Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
2761 about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2762 Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
2763 list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2764 your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2765
2766 @kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2767 @item --wrap=@var{symbol}
2768 Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2769 @var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2770 undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2771 @var{symbol}.
2772
2773 This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2774 wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2775 wishes to call the system function, it should call
2776 @code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2777
2778 Here is a trivial example:
2779
2780 @smallexample
2781 void *
2782 __wrap_malloc (size_t c)
2783 @{
2784 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
2785 return __real_malloc (c);
2786 @}
2787 @end smallexample
2788
2789 If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
2790 all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2791 instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2792 call the real @code{malloc} function.
2793
2794 You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
2795 links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
2796 you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2797 file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2798 call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2799
2800 Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2801 internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2802 @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2803 @code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 int
2807 f (void)
2808 @{
2809 return 123;
2810 @}
2811
2812 int
2813 g (void)
2814 @{
2815 return f();
2816 @}
2817 @end smallexample
2818
2819 @kindex --eh-frame-hdr
2820 @kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
2821 @item --eh-frame-hdr
2822 @itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2823 Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2824 (@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2825 section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
2826
2827 @kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2828 @item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2829 Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2830 generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2831 if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2832
2833 @kindex --enable-new-dtags
2834 @kindex --disable-new-dtags
2835 @item --enable-new-dtags
2836 @itemx --disable-new-dtags
2837 This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2838 systems may not understand them. If you specify
2839 @option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2840 and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
2841 If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
2842 created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2843 those options are only available for ELF systems.
2844
2845 @kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
2846 @item --hash-size=@var{number}
2847 Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2848 close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2849 time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2850 increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2851 value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2852
2853 @kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2854 @item --hash-style=@var{style}
2855 Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2856 @code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2857 new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2858 the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
2859 hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2860 but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
2861
2862 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2863 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2864 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2865 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2866 @item --compress-debug-sections=none
2867 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2868 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2869 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2870 On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2871 compressed using zlib.
2872
2873 @option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2874 sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2875 DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2876 instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2877 also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2878 sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2879
2880 The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2881 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2882
2883 Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2884 sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2885 for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2886 uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2887
2888 The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2889 involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2890 default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2891 @option{--help} option.
2892
2893 @kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2894 @item --reduce-memory-overheads
2895 This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
2896 linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
2897 for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2898 about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2899
2900 Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2901 1021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
2902 run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2903 has been used.
2904
2905 The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2906 enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
2907
2908 @kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2909 @item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2910 @command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
2911 of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
2912 maximum cache size to @var{size}.
2913
2914 @kindex --build-id
2915 @kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2916 @item --build-id
2917 @itemx --build-id=@var{style}
2918 Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
2919 or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
2920 unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2921 @code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2922 @sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2923 @code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2924 the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2925 string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2926 @code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2927 is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
2928
2929 The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2930 that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2931 unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2932 to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2933 file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2934 string identifying the original linked file does not change.
2935
2936 Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2937 @code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
2938 @end table
2939
2940 @c man end
2941
2942 @subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
2943
2944 @c man begin OPTIONS
2945
2946 The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
2947 the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2948 normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2949 use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2950 @code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2951 like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2952 symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2953 object file).
2954
2955 In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
2956 support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
2957 PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2958 values by either a space or an equals sign.
2959
2960 @table @gcctabopt
2961
2962 @kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2963 @item --add-stdcall-alias
2964 If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2965 as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
2966 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2967
2968 @kindex --base-file
2969 @item --base-file @var{file}
2970 Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2971 addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2972 @file{dlltool}.
2973 [This is an i386 PE specific option]
2974
2975 @kindex --dll
2976 @item --dll
2977 Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
2978 @option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
2979 file.
2980 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2981
2982 @kindex --enable-long-section-names
2983 @kindex --disable-long-section-names
2984 @item --enable-long-section-names
2985 @itemx --disable-long-section-names
2986 The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
2987 the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
2988 for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2989 fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
2990 to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2991 allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2992 disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2993 generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2994 as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
2995 with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2996 GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
2997 information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2998 option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2999 section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
3000 when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
3001 image and not stripping symbols.
3002 [This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
3003
3004 @kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
3005 @kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
3006 @item --enable-stdcall-fixup
3007 @itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
3008 If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
3009 do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
3010 only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
3011 resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
3012 undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
3013 @code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
3014 to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
3015 warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
3016 import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
3017 to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
3018 feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
3019 @option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
3020 mismatches are considered to be errors.
3021 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3022
3023 @kindex --leading-underscore
3024 @kindex --no-leading-underscore
3025 @item --leading-underscore
3026 @itemx --no-leading-underscore
3027 For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
3028 in target's description. By this option it is possible to
3029 disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
3030
3031 @cindex DLLs, creating
3032 @kindex --export-all-symbols
3033 @item --export-all-symbols
3034 If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
3035 be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
3036 otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
3037 explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
3038 attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
3039 option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
3040 @code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
3041 @code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
3042 exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3043 re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3044 such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3045 @code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
3046 @code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3047 Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3048 not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
3049 extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
3050 (obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
3051 These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3052 @code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
3053 @code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
3054 @code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
3055 @code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
3056 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3057
3058 @kindex --exclude-symbols
3059 @item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
3060 Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3061 exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
3062 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3063
3064 @kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3065 @item --exclude-all-symbols
3066 Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3067 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3068
3069 @kindex --file-alignment
3070 @item --file-alignment
3071 Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3072 file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3073 512.
3074 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3075
3076 @cindex heap size
3077 @kindex --heap
3078 @item --heap @var{reserve}
3079 @itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3080 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3081 to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
3082 committed.
3083 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3084
3085 @cindex image base
3086 @kindex --image-base
3087 @item --image-base @var{value}
3088 Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3089 the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3090 is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3091 your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3092 other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3093 for dlls.
3094 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3095
3096 @kindex --kill-at
3097 @item --kill-at
3098 If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3099 symbols before they are exported.
3100 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3101
3102 @kindex --large-address-aware
3103 @item --large-address-aware
3104 If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
3105 header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
3106 greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
3107 or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3108 section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3109 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3110
3111 @kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3112 @item --disable-large-address-aware
3113 Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3114 This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3115 driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3116 addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3117 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3118
3119 @kindex --major-image-version
3120 @item --major-image-version @var{value}
3121 Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
3122 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3123
3124 @kindex --major-os-version
3125 @item --major-os-version @var{value}
3126 Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
3127 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3128
3129 @kindex --major-subsystem-version
3130 @item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
3131 Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
3132 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3133
3134 @kindex --minor-image-version
3135 @item --minor-image-version @var{value}
3136 Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
3137 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3138
3139 @kindex --minor-os-version
3140 @item --minor-os-version @var{value}
3141 Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
3142 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3143
3144 @kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3145 @item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
3146 Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
3147 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3148
3149 @cindex DEF files, creating
3150 @cindex DLLs, creating
3151 @kindex --output-def
3152 @item --output-def @var{file}
3153 The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3154 file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3155 (which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3156 library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3157 automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
3158 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3159
3160 @cindex DLLs, creating
3161 @kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3162 @item --enable-auto-image-base
3163 @itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3164 Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3165 @var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3166 By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3167 for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3168 execution are avoided.
3169 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3170
3171 @kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3172 @item --disable-auto-image-base
3173 Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3174 user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3175 default.
3176 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3177
3178 @cindex DLLs, linking to
3179 @kindex --dll-search-prefix
3180 @item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
3181 When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
3182 search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
3183 @code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
3184 between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3185 uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
3186 @code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
3187 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3188
3189 @kindex --enable-auto-import
3190 @item --enable-auto-import
3191 Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
3192 DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3193 mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3194 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3195
3196 The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3197 feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3198
3199 Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3200 of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3201 PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
3202
3203 Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3204 data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3205 placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3206 around a problem with consts that is described here:
3207 http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3208
3209 Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3210 see this message:
3211
3212 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
3213 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3214
3215 This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3216 ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
3217 allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3218 fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3219 constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
3220 multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3221 this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3222 of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3223 the warning, and exit.
3224
3225 There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3226 data type of the exported variable:
3227
3228 One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3229 of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
3230 this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
3231
3232 A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3233 that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3234 there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
3235 a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3236
3237 @example
3238 extern type extern_array[];
3239 extern_array[1] -->
3240 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3241 @end example
3242
3243 or
3244
3245 @example
3246 extern type extern_array[];
3247 extern_array[1] -->
3248 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3249 @end example
3250
3251 For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
3252 is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
3253
3254 @example
3255 extern struct s extern_struct;
3256 extern_struct.field -->
3257 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3258 @end example
3259
3260 or
3261
3262 @example
3263 extern long long extern_ll;
3264 extern_ll -->
3265 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3266 @end example
3267
3268 A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
3269 'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
3270 @code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
3271 requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
3272 building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3273 merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3274 between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
3275 constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3276
3277 Original:
3278 @example
3279 --foo.h
3280 extern int arr[];
3281 --foo.c
3282 #include "foo.h"
3283 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3284 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3285 @}
3286 @end example
3287
3288 Solution 1:
3289 @example
3290 --foo.h
3291 extern int arr[];
3292 --foo.c
3293 #include "foo.h"
3294 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3295 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3296 volatile int *parr = arr;
3297 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3298 @}
3299 @end example
3300
3301 Solution 2:
3302 @example
3303 --foo.h
3304 /* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3305 #if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3306 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3307 #define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3308 #else
3309 #define FOO_IMPORT
3310 #endif
3311 extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3312 --foo.c
3313 #include "foo.h"
3314 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3315 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3316 @}
3317 @end example
3318
3319 A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
3320 library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3321 for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3322 functions).
3323
3324 @kindex --disable-auto-import
3325 @item --disable-auto-import
3326 Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
3327 @code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
3328 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3329
3330 @kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3331 @item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3332 If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3333 that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3334 a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
3335 environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
3336 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3337
3338 @kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3339 @item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3340 Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
3341 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3342
3343 @kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3344 @item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3345 Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
3346 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3347
3348 @kindex --section-alignment
3349 @item --section-alignment
3350 Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3351 addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
3352 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3353
3354 @cindex stack size
3355 @kindex --stack
3356 @item --stack @var{reserve}
3357 @itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3358 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3359 to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
3360 committed.
3361 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3362
3363 @kindex --subsystem
3364 @item --subsystem @var{which}
3365 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3366 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3367 Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3368 legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
3369 @code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3370 the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3371 @var{which}.
3372 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3373
3374 The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3375 of the PE file header:
3376 [These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3377
3378 @kindex --high-entropy-va
3379 @item --high-entropy-va
3380 @itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
3381 Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3382 (ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3383
3384 This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3385 @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3386
3387 @kindex --dynamicbase
3388 @item --dynamicbase
3389 @itemx --disable-dynamicbase
3390 The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3391 randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3392 Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3393 can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
3394 This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3395
3396 @kindex --forceinteg
3397 @item --forceinteg
3398 @itemx --disable-forceinteg
3399 Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3400 default.
3401
3402 @kindex --nxcompat
3403 @item --nxcompat
3404 @item --disable-nxcompat
3405 The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3406 This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3407 targets. The option is enabled by default.
3408
3409 @kindex --no-isolation
3410 @item --no-isolation
3411 @itemx --disable-no-isolation
3412 Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3413 This option is disabled by default.
3414
3415 @kindex --no-seh
3416 @item --no-seh
3417 @itemx --disable-no-seh
3418 The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3419 this image. This option is disabled by default.
3420
3421 @kindex --no-bind
3422 @item --no-bind
3423 @itemx --disable-no-bind
3424 Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
3425
3426 @kindex --wdmdriver
3427 @item --wdmdriver
3428 @itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3429 The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3430 by default.
3431
3432 @kindex --tsaware
3433 @item --tsaware
3434 @itemx --disable-tsaware
3435 The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3436 default.
3437
3438 @kindex --insert-timestamp
3439 @item --insert-timestamp
3440 @itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3441 Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3442 as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3443 other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
3444 will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
3445 same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3446 can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
3447 that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
3448 identically.
3449
3450 @kindex --enable-reloc-section
3451 @item --enable-reloc-section
3452 @itemx --disable-reloc-section
3453 Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3454 is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
3455 This option is enabled by default.
3456 @end table
3457
3458 @c man end
3459
3460 @ifset C6X
3461 @subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3462
3463 @c man begin OPTIONS
3464
3465 The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3466 libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3467 all executables use an index of 0.
3468
3469 @table @gcctabopt
3470
3471 @kindex --dsbt-size
3472 @item --dsbt-size @var{size}
3473 This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
3474 or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3475 entries.
3476
3477 @kindex --dsbt-index
3478 @item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3479 This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3480 to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3481 executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3482 @code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3483
3484 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3485 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3486 exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3487
3488 @end table
3489
3490 @c man end
3491 @end ifset
3492
3493 @ifset CSKY
3494 @subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3495
3496 @c man begin OPTIONS
3497
3498 @table @gcctabopt
3499
3500 @kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3501 @item --branch-stub
3502 This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3503 sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3504 usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3505 can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3506 the compiler or assembler.
3507
3508 @kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3509 @item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3510 This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3511 It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3512 be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3513 stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3514 sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3515 @samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3516 linker should choose suitable defaults.
3517
3518 @end table
3519
3520 @c man end
3521 @end ifset
3522
3523 @ifset M68HC11
3524 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3525
3526 @c man begin OPTIONS
3527
3528 The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3529 memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3530
3531 @table @gcctabopt
3532
3533 @kindex --no-trampoline
3534 @item --no-trampoline
3535 This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3536 is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3537 instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3538
3539 @kindex --bank-window
3540 @item --bank-window @var{name}
3541 This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3542 the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3543 The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3544 paging and addresses within the memory window.
3545
3546 @end table
3547
3548 @c man end
3549 @end ifset
3550
3551 @ifset M68K
3552 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3553
3554 @c man begin OPTIONS
3555
3556 The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3557 when linking for 68K targets.
3558
3559 @table @gcctabopt
3560
3561 @kindex --got
3562 @item --got=@var{type}
3563 This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3564 @var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3565 @samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3566 Info entry for @file{ld}.
3567
3568 @end table
3569
3570 @c man end
3571 @end ifset
3572
3573 @ifset MIPS
3574 @subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3575
3576 @c man begin OPTIONS
3577
3578 The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
3579 generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3580 linking for MIPS targets.
3581
3582 @table @gcctabopt
3583
3584 @kindex --insn32
3585 @item --insn32
3586 @kindex --no-insn32
3587 @itemx --no-insn32
3588 These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3589 generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3590 or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
3591 32-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3592 used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3593 possible.
3594
3595 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3596 @item --ignore-branch-isa
3597 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3598 @itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3599 These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3600 transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3601 accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3602 is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3603 instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3604 equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3605 calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3606 a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3607 an error.
3608
3609 @kindex --compact-branches
3610 @item --compact-branches
3611 @kindex --no-compact-branches
3612 @itemx --no-compact-branches
3613 These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3614 in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3615
3616 @end table
3617
3618 @c man end
3619 @end ifset
3620
3621
3622 @ifset PDP11
3623 @subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3624
3625 @c man begin OPTIONS
3626
3627 For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3628 produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3629 for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3630 targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3631 defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3632 here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3633
3634 @table @gcctabopt
3635
3636 @kindex -N
3637 @item -N
3638 @kindex --omagic
3639 @itemx --omagic
3640
3641 Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3642 indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3643 shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3644 writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3645 the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3646 programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3647 from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3648
3649 @kindex -n
3650 @item -n
3651 @kindex --nmagic
3652 @itemx --nmagic
3653
3654 Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3655 indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3656 be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3657 file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3658 byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3659 a @emph{pure executable} format.
3660
3661 @kindex -z
3662 @item -z
3663 @kindex --imagic
3664 @itemx --imagic
3665
3666 Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3667 indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3668 data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3669 instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3670 larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3671 to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3672 shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3673 option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3674 and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3675 this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3676 executable} format.
3677
3678 @kindex --no-omagic
3679 @item --no-omagic
3680
3681 Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3682
3683 @end table
3684
3685 @c man end
3686 @end ifset
3687
3688 @ifset UsesEnvVars
3689 @node Environment
3690 @section Environment Variables
3691
3692 @c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3693
3694 You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
3695 @ifclear SingleFormat
3696 @code{GNUTARGET},
3697 @end ifclear
3698 @code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
3699
3700 @ifclear SingleFormat
3701 @kindex GNUTARGET
3702 @cindex default input format
3703 @code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3704 use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3705 of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
3706 @code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
3707 of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3708 attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3709 this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3710 there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3711 object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3712 BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3713 in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
3714 @end ifclear
3715
3716 @kindex LDEMULATION
3717 @cindex default emulation
3718 @cindex emulation, default
3719 @code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3720 @samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3721 behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3722 available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3723 the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3724 variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3725 linker was configured.
3726
3727 @kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3728 @cindex demangling, default
3729 Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3730 @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3731 default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3732 a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3733 may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3734 options.
3735
3736 @c man end
3737 @end ifset
3738
3739 @node Scripts
3740 @chapter Linker Scripts
3741
3742 @cindex scripts
3743 @cindex linker scripts
3744 @cindex command files
3745 Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3746 written in the linker command language.
3747
3748 The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3749 the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3750 the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3751 more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3752 direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3753 described below.
3754
3755 The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3756 yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
3757 linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3758 to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
3759 such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3760
3761 You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3762 line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3763 default linker script.
3764
3765 You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3766 to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3767 Linker Scripts}.
3768
3769 @menu
3770 * Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3771 * Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3772 * Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3773 * Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3774 * Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3775 * SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3776 * MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3777 * PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3778 * VERSION:: VERSION Command
3779 * Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3780 * Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3781 @end menu
3782
3783 @node Basic Script Concepts
3784 @section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3785 @cindex linker script concepts
3786 We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3787 describe the linker script language.
3788
3789 The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3790 file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3791 @dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3792 The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3793 purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3794 among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3795 section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3796 in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3797
3798 Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3799 also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
3800 contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
3801 the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3802 A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3803 area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3804 loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3805 which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3806 of debugging information.
3807
3808 Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3809 first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3810 the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3811 @dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3812 section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3813 same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3814 is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3815 (this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3816 based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3817 RAM address would be the VMA.
3818
3819 You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3820 program with the @samp{-h} option.
3821
3822 Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3823 @dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3824 has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3825 information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3826 will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3827 static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3828 referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3829
3830 You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3831 program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3832 option.
3833
3834 @node Script Format
3835 @section Linker Script Format
3836 @cindex linker script format
3837 Linker scripts are text files.
3838
3839 You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3840 either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3841 symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3842 generally ignored.
3843
3844 Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3845 If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3846 otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3847 double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3848 file name.
3849
3850 You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3851 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3852 to whitespace.
3853
3854 @node Simple Example
3855 @section Simple Linker Script Example
3856 @cindex linker script example
3857 @cindex example of linker script
3858 Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3859
3860 The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3861 @samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3862 memory layout of the output file.
3863
3864 The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3865 describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3866 code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3867 @samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3868 Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3869 your input files.
3870
3871 For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
3872 0x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3873 linker script which will do that:
3874 @smallexample
3875 SECTIONS
3876 @{
3877 . = 0x10000;
3878 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3879 . = 0x8000000;
3880 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3881 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3882 @}
3883 @end smallexample
3884
3885 You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3886 followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3887 descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3888
3889 The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3890 sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3891 counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3892 other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3893 current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3894 incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3895 @samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3896
3897 The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3898 required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3899 after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3900 which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3901 wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3902 means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3903
3904 Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3905 @samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3906 @samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3907
3908 The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3909 the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3910 at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3911 output section, the value of the location counter will be
3912 @samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3913 effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
3914 immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
3915
3916 The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3917 alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3918 example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3919 sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3920 may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3921 sections.
3922
3923 That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3924
3925 @node Simple Commands
3926 @section Simple Linker Script Commands
3927 @cindex linker script simple commands
3928 In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3929
3930 @menu
3931 * Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3932 * File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3933 @ifclear SingleFormat
3934 * Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3935 @end ifclear
3936
3937 * REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
3938 * Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3939 @end menu
3940
3941 @node Entry Point
3942 @subsection Setting the Entry Point
3943 @kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3944 @cindex start of execution
3945 @cindex first instruction
3946 @cindex entry point
3947 The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3948 point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3949 entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3950 @smallexample
3951 ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3952 @end smallexample
3953
3954 There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3955 entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3956 stopping when one of them succeeds:
3957 @itemize @bullet
3958 @item
3959 the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
3960 @item
3961 the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
3962 @item
3963 the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
3964 targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3965 check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
3966 @item
3967 the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
3968 executable is being created - the code section is usually
3969 @samp{.text}, but can be something else;
3970 @item
3971 The address @code{0}.
3972 @end itemize
3973
3974 @node File Commands
3975 @subsection Commands Dealing with Files
3976 @cindex linker script file commands
3977 Several linker script commands deal with files.
3978
3979 @table @code
3980 @item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3981 @kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3982 @cindex including a linker script
3983 Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3984 be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
3985 with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
3986 10 levels deep.
3987
3988 You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3989 @code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3990
3991 @item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3992 @itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3993 @kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3994 @cindex input files in linker scripts
3995 @cindex input object files in linker scripts
3996 @cindex linker script input object files
3997 The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3998 in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3999
4000 For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
4001 a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
4002 then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
4003
4004 In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
4005 script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
4006
4007 In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
4008 with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
4009 located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
4010 for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
4011 @code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
4012 filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
4013 @samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4014
4015 If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
4016 the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
4017 found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
4018 not found the linker will search through the archive library search
4019 path.
4020
4021 If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
4022 name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
4023 @samp{-l}.
4024
4025 When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
4026 files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
4027 script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
4028
4029 @item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4030 @itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4031 @kindex GROUP(@var{files})
4032 @cindex grouping input files
4033 The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
4034 files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
4035 new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
4036 in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4037
4038 @item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4039 @itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4040 @kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
4041 This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
4042 commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
4043 as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4044 with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4045 when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4046 @option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4047 and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4048 setting afterwards.
4049
4050 @item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4051 @kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4052 @cindex output file name in linker script
4053 The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4054 @code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4055 @samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
4056 Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
4057 precedence.
4058
4059 You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4060 output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4061
4062 @item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4063 @kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4064 @cindex library search path in linker script
4065 @cindex archive search path in linker script
4066 @cindex search path in linker script
4067 The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
4068 @command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
4069 @code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
4070 on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
4071 are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
4072 the command-line option are searched first.
4073
4074 @item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4075 @kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4076 @cindex first input file
4077 The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4078 that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4079 though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4080 when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4081 first file.
4082 @end table
4083
4084 @ifclear SingleFormat
4085 @node Format Commands
4086 @subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
4087 A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4088
4089 @table @code
4090 @item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4091 @itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4092 @kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4093 @cindex output file format in linker script
4094 The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4095 output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
4096 exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4097 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
4098 line option takes precedence.
4099
4100 You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
4101 formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
4102 This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4103 desired endianness.
4104
4105 If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4106 will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4107 output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4108 used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4109
4110 For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4111 command:
4112 @smallexample
4113 OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4114 @end smallexample
4115 This says that the default format for the output file is
4116 @samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
4117 option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4118 format.
4119
4120 @item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4121 @kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4122 @cindex input file format in linker script
4123 The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4124 files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4125 This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
4126 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
4127 is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4128 command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4129 @end table
4130 @end ifclear
4131
4132 @node REGION_ALIAS
4133 @subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4134 @kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4135 @cindex region alias
4136 @cindex region names
4137
4138 Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4139 @ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4140
4141 @smallexample
4142 REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4143 @end smallexample
4144
4145 The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4146 memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4147 to memory regions. An example follows.
4148
4149 Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4150 memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4151 that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4152 non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4153 access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4154 read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4155 sections:
4156
4157 @itemize @bullet
4158 @item
4159 @code{.text} program code;
4160 @item
4161 @code{.rodata} read-only data;
4162 @item
4163 @code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4164 @item
4165 @code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4166 @end itemize
4167
4168 The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4169 part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4170 output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4171 systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4172 @code{C}:
4173 @multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4174 @item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
4175 @item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4176 @item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4177 @item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4178 @item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4179 @end multitable
4180 The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4181 loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4182 the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4183 the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4184
4185 The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4186 includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4187 memory layout:
4188 @smallexample
4189 INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4190
4191 SECTIONS
4192 @{
4193 .text :
4194 @{
4195 *(.text)
4196 @} > REGION_TEXT
4197 .rodata :
4198 @{
4199 *(.rodata)
4200 rodata_end = .;
4201 @} > REGION_RODATA
4202 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4203 @{
4204 data_start = .;
4205 *(.data)
4206 @} > REGION_DATA
4207 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4208 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4209 .bss :
4210 @{
4211 *(.bss)
4212 @} > REGION_BSS
4213 @}
4214 @end smallexample
4215
4216 Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4217 regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4218 variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4219 @table @code
4220 @item A
4221 Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4222 @smallexample
4223 MEMORY
4224 @{
4225 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4226 @}
4227
4228 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4229 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4230 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4231 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4232 @end smallexample
4233 @item B
4234 Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4235 into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4236 @code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4237 @smallexample
4238 MEMORY
4239 @{
4240 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4241 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4242 @}
4243
4244 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4245 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4246 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4247 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4248 @end smallexample
4249 @item C
4250 Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4251 @code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4252 initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4253 system start into the @code{RAM}.
4254 @smallexample
4255 MEMORY
4256 @{
4257 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4258 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4259 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4260 @}
4261
4262 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4263 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4264 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4265 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4266 @end smallexample
4267 @end table
4268
4269 It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4270 @code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4271 necessary:
4272 @smallexample
4273 #include <string.h>
4274
4275 extern char data_start [];
4276 extern char data_size [];
4277 extern char data_load_start [];
4278
4279 void copy_data(void)
4280 @{
4281 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4282 @{
4283 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4284 @}
4285 @}
4286 @end smallexample
4287
4288 @node Miscellaneous Commands
4289 @subsection Other Linker Script Commands
4290 There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4291
4292 @table @code
4293 @item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4294 @kindex ASSERT
4295 @cindex assertion in linker script
4296 Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4297 with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4298
4299 Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4300 take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4301 inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4302 for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4303 symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4304
4305 @smallexample
4306 .stack :
4307 @{
4308 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4309 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4310 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4311 @}
4312 @end smallexample
4313
4314 will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4315 PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4316 can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4317
4318 @smallexample
4319 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4320 .stack :
4321 @{
4322 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4323 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4324 @}
4325 @end smallexample
4326
4327 will work.
4328
4329 @item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4330 @kindex EXTERN
4331 @cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4332 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4333 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4334 modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4335 each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4336 command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4337
4338 @item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4339 @kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4340 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4341 This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
4342 to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
4343 output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4344
4345 @item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4346 @kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4347 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4348 This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4349 command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4350 to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4351
4352 @item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4353 @kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4354 @cindex group allocation in linker script
4355 @cindex section groups
4356 @cindex COMDAT
4357 This command has the same effect as the
4358 @samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4359 @command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4360 and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4361 specified (@samp{-r}).
4362
4363 @item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4364 @kindex INSERT
4365 @cindex insert user script into default script
4366 This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4367 augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4368 inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4369 @var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4370 default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4371 sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4372 linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4373 insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4374 linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4375 default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4376 of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4377 to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4378 is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4379
4380 @smallexample
4381 SECTIONS
4382 @{
4383 OVERLAY :
4384 @{
4385 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4386 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4387 @}
4388 @}
4389 INSERT AFTER .text;
4390 @end smallexample
4391
4392 @item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4393 @kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4394 @cindex cross references
4395 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4396 references among certain output sections.
4397
4398 In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4399 using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4400 will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4401 errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4402 a function defined in the other section.
4403
4404 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
4405 @command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
4406 an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4407 @code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4408 names.
4409
4410 @item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4411 @kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4412 @cindex cross references
4413 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4414 references to one section from a list of other sections.
4415
4416 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4417 output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4418 a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4419 there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4420 must never call back.
4421
4422 The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4423 The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4424 If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4425 the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4426 status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4427 names, not input section names.
4428
4429 @ifclear SingleFormat
4430 @item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4431 @kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4432 @cindex machine architecture
4433 @cindex architecture
4434 Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4435 of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4436 architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4437 the @samp{-f} option.
4438 @end ifclear
4439
4440 @item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4441 @kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4442 This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4443 @var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4444 in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4445 @xref{Expression Section}.
4446 @end table
4447
4448 @node Assignments
4449 @section Assigning Values to Symbols
4450 @cindex assignment in scripts
4451 @cindex symbol definition, scripts
4452 @cindex variables, defining
4453 You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
4454 the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
4455
4456 @menu
4457 * Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
4458 * HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
4459 * PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
4460 * PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4461 * Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
4462 @end menu
4463
4464 @node Simple Assignments
4465 @subsection Simple Assignments
4466
4467 You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4468
4469 @table @code
4470 @item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4471 @itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4472 @itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4473 @itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4474 @itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4475 @itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4476 @itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4477 @itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4478 @itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4479 @end table
4480
4481 The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4482 @var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4483 defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4484
4485 The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
4486 may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
4487
4488 The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4489
4490 Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4491
4492 You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4493 statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4494 section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4495
4496 The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4497 expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4498
4499 Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4500 assignments may be used:
4501
4502 @smallexample
4503 floating_point = 0;
4504 SECTIONS
4505 @{
4506 .text :
4507 @{
4508 *(.text)
4509 _etext = .;
4510 @}
4511 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
4512 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4513 @}
4514 @end smallexample
4515 @noindent
4516 In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4517 zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4518 the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4519 defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4520 upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4521
4522 @node HIDDEN
4523 @subsection HIDDEN
4524 @cindex HIDDEN
4525 For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4526 exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4527
4528 Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4529 @code{HIDDEN}:
4530
4531 @smallexample
4532 HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4533 SECTIONS
4534 @{
4535 .text :
4536 @{
4537 *(.text)
4538 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4539 @}
4540 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4541 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4542 @}
4543 @end smallexample
4544 @noindent
4545 In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4546
4547 @node PROVIDE
4548 @subsection PROVIDE
4549 @cindex PROVIDE
4550 In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4551 only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4552 the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4553 @samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4554 @samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4555 @code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4556 @samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4557 @code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4558
4559 Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4560 @smallexample
4561 SECTIONS
4562 @{
4563 .text :
4564 @{
4565 *(.text)
4566 _etext = .;
4567 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4568 @}
4569 @}
4570 @end smallexample
4571
4572 In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4573 underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4574 on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4575 underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4576 If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4577 linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4578
4579 Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4580 defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4581 that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4582 when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4583 @samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4584
4585 @node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4586 @subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4587 @cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4588 Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4589 hidden and won't be exported.
4590
4591 @node Source Code Reference
4592 @subsection Source Code Reference
4593
4594 Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4595 intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4596 a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4597 symbol that does not have a value.
4598
4599 Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4600 transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4601 stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4602 prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4603 mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4604 of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4605 variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4606 linker script variable might be referred to as:
4607
4608 @smallexample
4609 extern int foo;
4610 @end smallexample
4611
4612 But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4613
4614 @smallexample
4615 _foo = 1000;
4616 @end smallexample
4617
4618 In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4619 transformation has taken place.
4620
4621 When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4622 things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4623 in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4624 second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4625 table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4626 contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4627 value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4628
4629 @smallexample
4630 int foo = 1000;
4631 @end smallexample
4632
4633 creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
4634 holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4635 number 1000 is initially stored.
4636
4637 When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4638 first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4639 memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4640 So:
4641
4642 @smallexample
4643 foo = 1;
4644 @end smallexample
4645
4646 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4647 associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4648 address. Whereas:
4649
4650 @smallexample
4651 int * a = & foo;
4652 @end smallexample
4653
4654 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
4655 and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4656 the variable @samp{a}.
4657
4658 Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4659 the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4660 an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4661
4662 @smallexample
4663 foo = 1000;
4664 @end smallexample
4665
4666 creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4667 the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4668 address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4669 linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4670 access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4671
4672 Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4673 you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4674 use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4675 section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4676 linker script contains these declarations:
4677
4678 @smallexample
4679 @group
4680 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
4681 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
4682 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4683 @end group
4684 @end smallexample
4685
4686 Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4687
4688 @smallexample
4689 @group
4690 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
4691
4692 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4693 @end group
4694 @end smallexample
4695
4696 Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
4697 Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4698 arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4699
4700 @smallexample
4701 @group
4702 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4703
4704 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4705 @end group
4706 @end smallexample
4707
4708 Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4709 operators.
4710
4711 @node SECTIONS
4712 @section SECTIONS Command
4713 @kindex SECTIONS
4714 The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4715 into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4716
4717 The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4718 @smallexample
4719 SECTIONS
4720 @{
4721 @var{sections-command}
4722 @var{sections-command}
4723 @dots{}
4724 @}
4725 @end smallexample
4726
4727 Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4728
4729 @itemize @bullet
4730 @item
4731 an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4732 @item
4733 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4734 @item
4735 an output section description
4736 @item
4737 an overlay description
4738 @end itemize
4739
4740 The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4741 @code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4742 those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4743 understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4744 the layout of the output file.
4745
4746 Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4747 below.
4748
4749 If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4750 linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4751 section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4752 input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4753 example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4754 in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4755
4756 @menu
4757 * Output Section Description:: Output section description
4758 * Output Section Name:: Output section name
4759 * Output Section Address:: Output section address
4760 * Input Section:: Input section description
4761 * Output Section Data:: Output section data
4762 * Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4763 * Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4764 * Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4765 * Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4766 @end menu
4767
4768 @node Output Section Description
4769 @subsection Output Section Description
4770 The full description of an output section looks like this:
4771 @smallexample
4772 @group
4773 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
4774 [AT(@var{lma})]
4775 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
4776 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4777 [@var{constraint}]
4778 @{
4779 @var{output-section-command}
4780 @var{output-section-command}
4781 @dots{}
4782 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
4783 @end group
4784 @end smallexample
4785
4786 Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4787
4788 The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4789 name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
4790 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4791 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
4792 The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4793
4794 Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4795
4796 @itemize @bullet
4797 @item
4798 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4799 @item
4800 an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4801 @item
4802 data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4803 @item
4804 a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4805 @end itemize
4806
4807 @node Output Section Name
4808 @subsection Output Section Name
4809 @cindex name, section
4810 @cindex section name
4811 The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4812 meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4813 support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4814 must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4815 example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4816 output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4817 names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4818 quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4819 characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4820 commas must be quoted.
4821
4822 The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4823 Discarding}.
4824
4825 @node Output Section Address
4826 @subsection Output Section Address
4827 @cindex address, section
4828 @cindex section address
4829 The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
4830 address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4831 is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4832
4833 If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4834 section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4835 to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4836 alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4837 contained within the output section.
4838
4839 The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4840
4841 @itemize @bullet
4842 @item
4843 If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4844 is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4845 in that region.
4846
4847 @item
4848 If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4849 regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4850 section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4851 be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4852
4853 @item
4854 If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4855 the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4856 counter.
4857 @end itemize
4858
4859 @noindent
4860 For example:
4861
4862 @smallexample
4863 .text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4864 @end smallexample
4865
4866 @noindent
4867 and
4868
4869 @smallexample
4870 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4871 @end smallexample
4872
4873 @noindent
4874 are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4875 @samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4876 counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
4877 counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4878 input sections.
4879
4880 The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4881 For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4882 so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4883 do something like this:
4884 @smallexample
4885 .text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4886 @end smallexample
4887 @noindent
4888 This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4889 aligned upward to the specified value.
4890
4891 Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
4892 location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4893 sections are ignored).
4894
4895 @node Input Section
4896 @subsection Input Section Description
4897 @cindex input sections
4898 @cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4899 The most common output section command is an input section description.
4900
4901 The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4902 You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4903 in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4904 map the input files into your memory layout.
4905
4906 @menu
4907 * Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4908 * Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4909 * Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4910 * Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4911 * Input Section Example:: Input section example
4912 @end menu
4913
4914 @node Input Section Basics
4915 @subsubsection Input Section Basics
4916 @cindex input section basics
4917 An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4918 by a list of section names in parentheses.
4919
4920 The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4921 describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4922
4923 The most common input section description is to include all input
4924 sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4925 include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4926 @smallexample
4927 *(.text)
4928 @end smallexample
4929 @noindent
4930 Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
4931 @cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
4932 of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4933 match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4934 example:
4935 @smallexample
4936 EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4937 @end smallexample
4938 @noindent
4939 will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4940 and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4941 placed inside the section list, for example:
4942 @smallexample
4943 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
4944 @end smallexample
4945 @noindent
4946 The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4947 two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4948 more than one section, as described below.
4949
4950 There are two ways to include more than one section:
4951 @smallexample
4952 *(.text .rdata)
4953 *(.text) *(.rdata)
4954 @end smallexample
4955 @noindent
4956 The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4957 @samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
4958 first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4959 they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
4960 @samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4961 @samp{.rdata} input sections.
4962
4963 When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4964 is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4965 immediately following section, for example:
4966 @smallexample
4967 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4968 @end smallexample
4969 @noindent
4970 will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4971 @file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4972 from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4973 exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
4974 could be modified to:
4975 @smallexample
4976 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4977 @end smallexample
4978 @noindent
4979 Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4980 before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4981 all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4982 @smallexample
4983 EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4984 @end smallexample
4985
4986 You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4987 You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4988 needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4989 @smallexample
4990 data.o(.data)
4991 @end smallexample
4992
4993 To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4994 of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4995
4996 Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4997
4998 @smallexample
4999 @group
5000 SECTIONS @{
5001 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
5002 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
5003 @}
5004 @end group
5005 @end smallexample
5006
5007 In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
5008 input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
5009 @code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
5010 @samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
5011 whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
5012
5013 You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
5014 matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
5015 with no whitespace around the colon.
5016
5017 @table @samp
5018 @item archive:file
5019 matches file within archive
5020 @item archive:
5021 matches the whole archive
5022 @item :file
5023 matches file but not one in an archive
5024 @end table
5025
5026 Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
5027 wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
5028 single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
5029 @samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
5030 within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
5031 also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
5032 other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
5033 from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
5034 command.
5035
5036 If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
5037 the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
5038 commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
5039 @smallexample
5040 data.o
5041 @end smallexample
5042
5043 When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5044 and does not contain any wild card
5045 characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5046 name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5047 did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5048 though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5049 @code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5050 the archive search path.
5051
5052 @node Input Section Wildcards
5053 @subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
5054 @cindex input section wildcards
5055 @cindex wildcard file name patterns
5056 @cindex file name wildcard patterns
5057 @cindex section name wildcard patterns
5058 In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5059 name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5060
5061 The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5062 pattern for the file name.
5063
5064 The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5065
5066 @table @samp
5067 @item *
5068 matches any number of characters
5069 @item ?
5070 matches any single character
5071 @item [@var{chars}]
5072 matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5073 character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5074 @samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5075 @item \
5076 quotes the following character
5077 @end table
5078
5079 File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5080 specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5081 does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5082
5083 If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5084 appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5085 will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5086 sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5087 @file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5088 @smallexample
5089 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5090 .data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5091 @end smallexample
5092
5093 @cindex SORT_BY_NAME
5094 Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5095 in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
5096 this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5097 pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5098 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
5099 into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5100
5101 @cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
5102 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5103 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5104 alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5105 alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5106 needed.
5107
5108 @cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
5109 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5110 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5111 numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5112 section name before placing them in the output file. In
5113 @code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5114 the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5115 @code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
5116
5117 @cindex SORT
5118 @code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5119
5120 When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5121 can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5122
5123 @enumerate
5124 @item
5125 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5126 It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
5127 sections have the same name.
5128 @item
5129 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5130 It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
5131 sections have the same alignment.
5132 @item
5133 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
5134 treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5135 @item
5136 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5137 is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5138 @item
5139 All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5140 @end enumerate
5141
5142 When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
5143 section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
5144 takes precedence over the command-line option.
5145
5146 If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
5147 command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
5148 treated as nested sorting command.
5149
5150 @enumerate
5151 @item
5152 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5153 @option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5154 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5155 @item
5156 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5157 @option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5158 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5159 @end enumerate
5160
5161 If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
5162 command-line option will be ignored.
5163
5164 @cindex SORT_NONE
5165 @code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
5166 section sorting option.
5167
5168 If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5169 @samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5170 precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5171
5172 This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5173 files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5174 sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5175 The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5176 with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5177 linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5178 @smallexample
5179 @group
5180 SECTIONS @{
5181 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5182 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5183 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5184 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5185 @}
5186 @end group
5187 @end smallexample
5188
5189 @node Input Section Common
5190 @subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
5191 @cindex common symbol placement
5192 @cindex uninitialized data placement
5193 A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5194 file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5195 linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5196 named @samp{COMMON}.
5197
5198 You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5199 other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5200 particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5201 input files are placed in another section.
5202
5203 In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5204 @samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5205 @smallexample
5206 .bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5207 @end smallexample
5208
5209 @cindex scommon section
5210 @cindex small common symbols
5211 Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5212 example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5213 symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5214 different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5215 the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5216 symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5217 to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5218 locations.
5219
5220 @cindex [COMMON]
5221 You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5222 notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5223 @samp{*(COMMON)}.
5224
5225 @node Input Section Keep
5226 @subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
5227 @cindex KEEP
5228 @cindex garbage collection
5229 When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
5230 it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
5231 This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5232 with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
5233 @code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
5234
5235 @node Input Section Example
5236 @subsubsection Input Section Example
5237 The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5238 to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5239 start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5240 @samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5241 follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5242 @samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5243 @samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5244 All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5245 files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5246
5247 @smallexample
5248 @group
5249 SECTIONS @{
5250 outputa 0x10000 :
5251 @{
5252 all.o
5253 foo.o (.input1)
5254 @}
5255 @end group
5256 @group
5257 outputb :
5258 @{
5259 foo.o (.input2)
5260 foo1.o (.input1)
5261 @}
5262 @end group
5263 @group
5264 outputc :
5265 @{
5266 *(.input1)
5267 *(.input2)
5268 @}
5269 @}
5270 @end group
5271 @end smallexample
5272
5273 If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5274 and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5275 automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5276 __stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5277 indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5278 respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5279 C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5280
5281 @node Output Section Data
5282 @subsection Output Section Data
5283 @cindex data
5284 @cindex section data
5285 @cindex output section data
5286 @kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5287 @kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5288 @kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5289 @kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5290 @kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5291 You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5292 @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5293 an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5294 parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5295 value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5296 counter.
5297
5298 The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5299 store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5300 bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5301 stored.
5302
5303 For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5304 of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5305 @smallexample
5306 BYTE(1)
5307 LONG(addr)
5308 @end smallexample
5309
5310 When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5311 same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5312 target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5313 @code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5314 @code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5315
5316 If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5317 which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5318 When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5319 true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5320 endianness of the first input object file.
5321
5322 Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
5323 between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5324 @smallexample
5325 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5326 @end smallexample
5327 whereas this will work:
5328 @smallexample
5329 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5330 @end smallexample
5331
5332 @kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5333 @cindex holes, filling
5334 @cindex unspecified memory
5335 You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5336 current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5337 otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5338 gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
5339 with the value of the expression, repeated as
5340 necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5341 point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5342 than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5343 different parts of an output section.
5344
5345 This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
5346 value @samp{0x90}:
5347 @smallexample
5348 FILL(0x90909090)
5349 @end smallexample
5350
5351 The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
5352 section attribute, but it only affects the
5353 part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5354 entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
5355 precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
5356 expression.
5357
5358 @node Output Section Keywords
5359 @subsection Output Section Keywords
5360 There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5361 commands.
5362
5363 @table @code
5364 @kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5365 @cindex input filename symbols
5366 @cindex filename symbols
5367 @item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5368 The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5369 The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5370 file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5371 the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5372
5373 This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5374 normally used for any other object file format.
5375
5376 @kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5377 @cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5378 @cindex constructors, arranging in link
5379 @item CONSTRUCTORS
5380 When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5381 unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5382 destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5383 arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5384 automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5385 For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5386 linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5387 @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5388 ignored for other object file formats.
5389
5390 The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
5391 constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5392 Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5393 the start and end of the global destructors. The
5394 first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5395 of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5396 compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5397 formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5398 @code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5399 the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5400 destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5401 @code{exit}.
5402
5403 For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5404 arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5405 addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5406 and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5407 linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5408 runtime code expects to see.
5409
5410 @smallexample
5411 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5412 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5413 *(.ctors)
5414 LONG(0)
5415 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5416 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5417 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5418 *(.dtors)
5419 LONG(0)
5420 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5421 @end smallexample
5422
5423 If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5424 which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5425 are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5426 are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
5427 command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5428 @code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5429 @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
5430 @samp{*(.dtors)}.
5431
5432 Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5433 and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5434 need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5435 scripts.
5436
5437 @end table
5438
5439 @node Output Section Discarding
5440 @subsection Output Section Discarding
5441 @cindex discarding sections
5442 @cindex sections, discarding
5443 @cindex removing sections
5444 The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5445 This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5446 may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
5447 @smallexample
5448 .foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
5449 @end smallexample
5450 @noindent
5451 will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
5452 @samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5453 sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
5454 space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5455 too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5456 space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5457 @samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5458 @samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5459 This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
5460
5461 The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
5462 on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5463 symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
5464 the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5465 section is discarded.
5466
5467 @cindex /DISCARD/
5468 The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5469 input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5470 section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5471
5472 This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5473 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5474 garbage collection.
5475
5476 Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5477 discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5478 members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5479 Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5480
5481 @node Output Section Attributes
5482 @subsection Output Section Attributes
5483 @cindex output section attributes
5484 We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5485 like this:
5486
5487 @smallexample
5488 @group
5489 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
5490 [AT(@var{lma})]
5491 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
5492 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5493 [@var{constraint}]
5494 @{
5495 @var{output-section-command}
5496 @var{output-section-command}
5497 @dots{}
5498 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
5499 @end group
5500 @end smallexample
5501
5502 We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5503 @var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5504 remaining section attributes.
5505
5506 @menu
5507 * Output Section Type:: Output section type
5508 * Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
5509 * Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
5510 * Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
5511 * Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
5512 * Output Section Region:: Output section region
5513 * Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5514 * Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5515 @end menu
5516
5517 @node Output Section Type
5518 @subsubsection Output Section Type
5519 Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5520 parentheses. The following types are defined:
5521
5522 @table @code
5523 @item NOLOAD
5524 The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5525 loaded into memory when the program is run.
5526 @item READONLY
5527 The section should be marked as read-only.
5528 @item DSECT
5529 @item COPY
5530 @item INFO
5531 @item OVERLAY
5532 These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5533 rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5534 marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5535 section when the program is run.
5536 @item TYPE = @var{type}
5537 Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF
5538 output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB},
5539 @code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY},
5540 @code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed
5541 for @var{type}. It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any
5542 special requirements of the section type are met.
5543 @item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} )
5544 This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the
5545 type specified by @var{type}.
5546 @end table
5547
5548 @kindex NOLOAD
5549 @cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5550 @cindex loading, preventing
5551 The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5552 the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5553 the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5554 @samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
5555 need to be loaded when the program is run.
5556 @smallexample
5557 @group
5558 SECTIONS @{
5559 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5560 @dots{}
5561 @}
5562 @end group
5563 @end smallexample
5564
5565 @node Output Section LMA
5566 @subsubsection Output Section LMA
5567 @kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
5568 @kindex AT(@var{lma})
5569 @cindex load address
5570 @cindex section load address
5571 Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
5572 @ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5573 @pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5574 specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5575 address is optional.
5576
5577 The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5578 specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5579 takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5580 load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5581 region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
5582
5583 If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
5584 section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5585 load address:
5586
5587 @itemize @bullet
5588 @item
5589 If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5590 the LMA address as well.
5591
5592 @item
5593 If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5594
5595 @item
5596 Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5597 with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5598 section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5599 VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5600 the last section in the located region.
5601
5602 @item
5603 If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5604 that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5605
5606 @item
5607 If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5608 section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5609 @end itemize
5610
5611 @cindex ROM initialized data
5612 @cindex initialized data in ROM
5613 This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5614 example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5615 called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5616 @samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5617 even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5618 uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5619 defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5620 counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5621
5622 @smallexample
5623 @group
5624 SECTIONS
5625 @{
5626 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
5627 .mdata 0x2000 :
5628 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5629 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5630 .bss 0x3000 :
5631 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5632 @}
5633 @end group
5634 @end smallexample
5635
5636 The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5637 this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5638 the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5639 how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5640 script.
5641
5642 @smallexample
5643 @group
5644 extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5645 char *src = &_etext;
5646 char *dst = &_data;
5647
5648 /* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5649 while (dst < &_edata)
5650 *dst++ = *src++;
5651
5652 /* Zero bss. */
5653 for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5654 *dst = 0;
5655 @end group
5656 @end smallexample
5657
5658 @node Forced Output Alignment
5659 @subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5660 @kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5661 @cindex forcing output section alignment
5662 @cindex output section alignment
5663 You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
5664 alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5665 intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
5666
5667 @node Forced Input Alignment
5668 @subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5669 @kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5670 @cindex forcing input section alignment
5671 @cindex input section alignment
5672 You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5673 SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5674 sections, whether larger or smaller.
5675
5676 @node Output Section Constraint
5677 @subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5678 @kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5679 @kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5680 @cindex constraints on output sections
5681 You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5682 of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5683 read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5684 @code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5685
5686 @node Output Section Region
5687 @subsubsection Output Section Region
5688 @kindex >@var{region}
5689 @cindex section, assigning to memory region
5690 @cindex memory regions and sections
5691 You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5692 using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5693
5694 Here is a simple example:
5695 @smallexample
5696 @group
5697 MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5698 SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5699 @end group
5700 @end smallexample
5701
5702 @node Output Section Phdr
5703 @subsubsection Output Section Phdr
5704 @kindex :@var{phdr}
5705 @cindex section, assigning to program header
5706 @cindex program headers and sections
5707 You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5708 using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5709 one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5710 assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5711 @code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5712 linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5713
5714 Here is a simple example:
5715 @smallexample
5716 @group
5717 PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5718 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5719 @end group
5720 @end smallexample
5721
5722 @node Output Section Fill
5723 @subsubsection Output Section Fill
5724 @kindex =@var{fillexp}
5725 @cindex section fill pattern
5726 @cindex fill pattern, entire section
5727 You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5728 @samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5729 (@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5730 within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
5731 alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5732 necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
5733 of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
5734 an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5735 fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
5736 other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
5737 pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5738 expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
5739
5740 You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
5741 output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
5742
5743 Here is a simple example:
5744 @smallexample
5745 @group
5746 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
5747 @end group
5748 @end smallexample
5749
5750 @node Overlay Description
5751 @subsection Overlay Description
5752 @kindex OVERLAY
5753 @cindex overlays
5754 An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5755 are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5756 the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5757 copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5758 required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5759 can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5760 than another.
5761
5762 Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5763 @code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5764 output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5765 command is as follows:
5766 @smallexample
5767 @group
5768 OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5769 @{
5770 @var{secname1}
5771 @{
5772 @var{output-section-command}
5773 @var{output-section-command}
5774 @dots{}
5775 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5776 @var{secname2}
5777 @{
5778 @var{output-section-command}
5779 @var{output-section-command}
5780 @dots{}
5781 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5782 @dots{}
5783 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
5784 @end group
5785 @end smallexample
5786
5787 Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5788 section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5789 section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
5790 those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
5791 except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5792 sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5793
5794 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5795 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5796
5797 The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5798 addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5799 memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5800 whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5801 and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5802 and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5803
5804 If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5805 references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5806 the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5807 sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5808 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
5809
5810 For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
5811 provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
5812 defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5813 @code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5814 the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5815 within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5816 symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5817
5818 At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5819 the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5820
5821 Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5822 @code{SECTIONS} construct.
5823 @smallexample
5824 @group
5825 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5826 @{
5827 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5828 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5829 @}
5830 @end group
5831 @end smallexample
5832 @noindent
5833 This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5834 address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5835 @samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
5836 following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
5837 @code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5838 @code{__load_stop_text1}.
5839
5840 C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5841 like the following.
5842
5843 @smallexample
5844 @group
5845 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5846 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5847 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5848 @end group
5849 @end smallexample
5850
5851 Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5852 everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5853 example could have been written identically as follows.
5854
5855 @smallexample
5856 @group
5857 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5858 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5859 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
5860 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5861 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5862 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
5863 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5864 @end group
5865 @end smallexample
5866
5867 @node MEMORY
5868 @section MEMORY Command
5869 @kindex MEMORY
5870 @cindex memory regions
5871 @cindex regions of memory
5872 @cindex allocating memory
5873 @cindex discontinuous memory
5874 The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5875 memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5876
5877 The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5878 memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5879 may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5880 can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5881 set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5882 regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5883 around to fit into the available regions.
5884
5885 A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5886 however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5887 specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5888 @code{MEMORY} is:
5889 @smallexample
5890 @group
5891 MEMORY
5892 @{
5893 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5894 @dots{}
5895 @}
5896 @end group
5897 @end smallexample
5898
5899 The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5900 region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5901 Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5902 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
5903 must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5904 add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
5905 command.
5906
5907 @cindex memory region attributes
5908 The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5909 whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5910 not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5911 @ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5912 section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5913 the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5914 them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5915
5916 The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5917 @table @samp
5918 @item R
5919 Read-only section
5920 @item W
5921 Read/write section
5922 @item X
5923 Executable section
5924 @item A
5925 Allocatable section
5926 @item I
5927 Initialized section
5928 @item L
5929 Same as @samp{I}
5930 @item !
5931 Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
5932 @end table
5933
5934 If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
5935 @samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
5936 attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5937 unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5938 not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5939 string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5940 or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5941 the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
5942
5943 @kindex ORIGIN =
5944 @kindex o =
5945 @kindex org =
5946 The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5947 the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5948 cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5949 abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5950 @code{ORG}).
5951
5952 @kindex LENGTH =
5953 @kindex len =
5954 @kindex l =
5955 The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5956 region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
5957 be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5958 @code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
5959
5960 In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5961 available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5962 and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5963 linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5964 is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5965 or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5966 explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5967 region.
5968
5969 @smallexample
5970 @group
5971 MEMORY
5972 @{
5973 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5974 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5975 @}
5976 @end group
5977 @end smallexample
5978
5979 Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5980 specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5981 @samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5982 a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5983 output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5984 was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5985 the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5986 output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5987 region, the linker will issue an error message.
5988
5989 It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
5990 expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
5991 @code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5992
5993 @smallexample
5994 @group
5995 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
5996 @end group
5997 @end smallexample
5998
5999 @node PHDRS
6000 @section PHDRS Command
6001 @kindex PHDRS
6002 @cindex program headers
6003 @cindex ELF program headers
6004 @cindex program segments
6005 @cindex segments, ELF
6006 The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
6007 @dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
6008 loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
6009 program with the @samp{-p} option.
6010
6011 When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
6012 reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
6013 program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
6014 This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
6015 interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
6016
6017 The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
6018 in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
6019 precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
6020 the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
6021 not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
6022
6023 The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
6024 generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
6025 ignore @code{PHDRS}.
6026
6027 This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
6028 @code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
6029
6030 @smallexample
6031 @group
6032 PHDRS
6033 @{
6034 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
6035 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
6036 @}
6037 @end group
6038 @end smallexample
6039
6040 The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
6041 of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
6042 header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6043 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
6044 must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
6045 is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
6046
6047 Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
6048 system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
6049 specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
6050 sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
6051 attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
6052 Section Phdr}.
6053
6054 It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6055 merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6056 repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6057 contain the section.
6058
6059 If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6060 then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6061 not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6062 convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6063 placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6064 default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6065 segment at all.
6066
6067 @kindex FILEHDR
6068 @kindex PHDRS
6069 You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
6070 the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6071 The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6072 file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
6073 include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
6074 segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6075 these keywords.
6076
6077 The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6078 value of the keyword.
6079
6080 @table @asis
6081 @item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6082 Indicates an unused program header.
6083
6084 @item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6085 Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6086 the file.
6087
6088 @item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6089 Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6090
6091 @item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6092 Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6093 found.
6094
6095 @item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6096 Indicates a segment holding note information.
6097
6098 @item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6099 A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6100 ABI.
6101
6102 @item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6103 Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6104
6105 @item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6106 Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6107
6108 @item @var{expression}
6109 An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6110 be used for types not defined above.
6111 @end table
6112
6113 You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6114 in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6115 @code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6116 Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6117 output section attribute.
6118
6119 The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6120 which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6121 explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6122 an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6123 header.
6124
6125 Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6126 headers used on a native ELF system.
6127
6128 @example
6129 @group
6130 PHDRS
6131 @{
6132 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6133 interp PT_INTERP ;
6134 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6135 data PT_LOAD ;
6136 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6137 @}
6138
6139 SECTIONS
6140 @{
6141 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6142 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6143 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6144 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6145 @dots{}
6146 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6147 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6148 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6149 @dots{}
6150 @}
6151 @end group
6152 @end example
6153
6154 @node VERSION
6155 @section VERSION Command
6156 @kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6157 @cindex symbol versions
6158 @cindex version script
6159 @cindex versions of symbols
6160 The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6161 only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6162 symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6163 a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6164 shared library.
6165
6166 You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6167 you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6168 also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6169
6170 The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6171 @smallexample
6172 VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6173 @end smallexample
6174
6175 The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6176 Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6177 version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6178 version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6179 version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6180 scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6181 library.
6182
6183 The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6184 examples.
6185
6186 @smallexample
6187 VERS_1.1 @{
6188 global:
6189 foo1;
6190 local:
6191 old*;
6192 original*;
6193 new*;
6194 @};
6195
6196 VERS_1.2 @{
6197 foo2;
6198 @} VERS_1.1;
6199
6200 VERS_2.0 @{
6201 bar1; bar2;
6202 extern "C++" @{
6203 ns::*;
6204 "f(int, double)";
6205 @};
6206 @} VERS_1.2;
6207 @end smallexample
6208
6209 This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6210 version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6211 The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6212 a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
6213 of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6214 symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6215 is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6216 in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
6217 However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6218 name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
6219
6220 Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6221 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6222 to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6223
6224 Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6225 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6226 and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6227
6228 When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6229 specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6230 unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
6231 unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
6232 somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6233 wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6234 wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6235 set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6236 ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
6237
6238 The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6239 they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6240 could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6241 However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6242
6243 Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6244 in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6245 symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6246 won't.
6247
6248 @smallexample
6249 @{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
6250 @end smallexample
6251
6252 When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6253 symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6254 requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6255 shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6256 loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6257 linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6258 application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6259 way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6260 all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6261 search for each symbol reference.
6262
6263 The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6264 doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6265 that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6266 functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6267 the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6268 required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6269 that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6270 versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6271 the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6272
6273 There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6274 first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6275 source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6276 script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6277 maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6278 @smallexample
6279 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6280 @end smallexample
6281 @noindent
6282 in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6283 be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6284 The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
6285 @samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6286 takes precedence over a version script.
6287
6288 The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6289 function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6290 an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6291 version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6292 linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6293
6294 To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6295 source file. Here is an example:
6296
6297 @smallexample
6298 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6299 __asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6300 __asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6301 __asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6302 @end smallexample
6303
6304 In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6305 unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6306 example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6307 @samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6308
6309 When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6310 some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6311 this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6312 @samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6313 declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6314 you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6315
6316 If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6317 within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
6318 (i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
6319 specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6320
6321 You can also specify the language in the version script:
6322
6323 @smallexample
6324 VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6325 @end smallexample
6326
6327 The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
6328 The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6329 demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
6330 patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6331 @samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
6332
6333 Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6334 described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6335 or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6336 the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6337 whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6338 cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6339 might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6340 should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6341 expect when you upgrade.
6342
6343 @node Expressions
6344 @section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6345 @cindex expressions
6346 @cindex arithmetic
6347 The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6348 that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6349 places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6350 evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6351 size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6352 otherwise 64 bits.
6353
6354 You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6355
6356 The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6357 expressions.
6358
6359 @menu
6360 * Constants:: Constants
6361 * Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
6362 * Symbols:: Symbol Names
6363 * Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
6364 * Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6365 * Operators:: Operators
6366 * Evaluation:: Evaluation
6367 * Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6368 * Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6369 @end menu
6370
6371 @node Constants
6372 @subsection Constants
6373 @cindex integer notation
6374 @cindex constants in linker scripts
6375 All constants are integers.
6376
6377 As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6378 octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
6379 hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
6380 @samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
6381 @samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6382 value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
6383
6384 @cindex scaled integers
6385 @cindex K and M integer suffixes
6386 @cindex M and K integer suffixes
6387 @cindex suffixes for integers
6388 @cindex integer suffixes
6389 In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6390 constant by
6391 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6392 @ifnottex
6393 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6394 @code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6395 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6396 @end ifnottex
6397 @tex
6398 ${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6399 @end tex
6400 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6401 respectively. For example, the following
6402 all refer to the same quantity:
6403
6404 @smallexample
6405 _fourk_1 = 4K;
6406 _fourk_2 = 4096;
6407 _fourk_3 = 0x1000;
6408 _fourk_4 = 10000o;
6409 @end smallexample
6410
6411 Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6412 conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6413
6414 @node Symbolic Constants
6415 @subsection Symbolic Constants
6416 @cindex symbolic constants
6417 @kindex CONSTANT
6418 It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
6419 the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6420
6421 @table @code
6422 @item MAXPAGESIZE
6423 @kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6424 The target's maximum page size.
6425
6426 @item COMMONPAGESIZE
6427 @kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6428 The target's default page size.
6429 @end table
6430
6431 So for example:
6432
6433 @smallexample
6434 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
6435 @end smallexample
6436
6437 will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6438 supported by the target.
6439
6440 @node Symbols
6441 @subsection Symbol Names
6442 @cindex symbol names
6443 @cindex names
6444 @cindex quoted symbol names
6445 @kindex "
6446 Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6447 and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6448 Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6449 specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6450 keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6451 @smallexample
6452 "SECTION" = 9;
6453 "with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
6454 @end smallexample
6455
6456 Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6457 to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6458 whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6459
6460 @node Orphan Sections
6461 @subsection Orphan Sections
6462 @cindex orphan
6463 Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6464 are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6465 script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
6466 output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6467 in which to place the orphaned input section.
6468
6469 If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6470 an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6471 placed at the end of that output section.
6472
6473 If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6474 sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6475 name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6476 orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6477 one new output section.
6478
6479 If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6480 then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
6481 in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6482 linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6483 attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6484 sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6485 support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
6486
6487 The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6488 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
6489 output sections an orphan is placed in.
6490
6491 @node Location Counter
6492 @subsection The Location Counter
6493 @kindex .
6494 @cindex dot
6495 @cindex location counter
6496 @cindex current output location
6497 The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6498 current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6499 location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6500 within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6501 anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6502
6503 @cindex holes
6504 Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6505 moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
6506 location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6507 and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6508 doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
6509
6510 @smallexample
6511 SECTIONS
6512 @{
6513 output :
6514 @{
6515 file1(.text)
6516 . = . + 1000;
6517 file2(.text)
6518 . += 1000;
6519 file3(.text)
6520 @} = 0x12345678;
6521 @}
6522 @end smallexample
6523 @noindent
6524 In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6525 located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6526 followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6527 @file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
6528 @samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
6529 specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6530
6531 @cindex dot inside sections
6532 Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6533 current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
6534 statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
6535 absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6536 however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6537 not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6538
6539 @smallexample
6540 SECTIONS
6541 @{
6542 . = 0x100
6543 .text: @{
6544 *(.text)
6545 . = 0x200
6546 @}
6547 . = 0x500
6548 .data: @{
6549 *(.data)
6550 . += 0x600
6551 @}
6552 @}
6553 @end smallexample
6554
6555 The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6556 and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6557 the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6558 much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6559 move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6560 and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6561 the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6562 the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6563
6564 @cindex dot outside sections
6565 Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6566 output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6567 needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6568
6569 @smallexample
6570 SECTIONS
6571 @{
6572 start_of_text = . ;
6573 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6574 end_of_text = . ;
6575
6576 start_of_data = . ;
6577 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6578 end_of_data = . ;
6579 @}
6580 @end smallexample
6581
6582 If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6583 not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6584 between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6585 should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6586 blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6587 the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6588 sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6589 statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6590 special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6591 place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6592 as follows:
6593
6594 @smallexample
6595 SECTIONS
6596 @{
6597 start_of_text = . ;
6598 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6599 end_of_text = . ;
6600
6601 start_of_data = . ;
6602 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6603 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6604 end_of_data = . ;
6605 @}
6606 @end smallexample
6607
6608 This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6609 @code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6610 placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6611 assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6612 a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6613 section. So you could write:
6614
6615 @smallexample
6616 SECTIONS
6617 @{
6618 start_of_text = . ;
6619 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6620 end_of_text = . ;
6621
6622 . = . ;
6623 start_of_data = . ;
6624 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6625 end_of_data = . ;
6626 @}
6627 @end smallexample
6628
6629 Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6630 @code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6631
6632 @need 2000
6633 @node Operators
6634 @subsection Operators
6635 @cindex operators for arithmetic
6636 @cindex arithmetic operators
6637 @cindex precedence in expressions
6638 The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6639 the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6640 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6641 @ifnottex
6642 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6643 @smallexample
6644 precedence associativity Operators Notes
6645 (highest)
6646 1 left ! - ~ (1)
6647 2 left * / %
6648 3 left + -
6649 4 left >> <<
6650 5 left == != > < <= >=
6651 6 left &
6652 7 left |
6653 8 left &&
6654 9 left ||
6655 10 right ? :
6656 11 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6657 (lowest)
6658 @end smallexample
6659 Notes:
6660 (1) Prefix operators
6661 (2) @xref{Assignments}.
6662 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6663 @end ifnottex
6664 @tex
6665 \vskip \baselineskip
6666 %"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6667 \hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6668 \hrule
6669 \halign
6670 {\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6671 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6672 &Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6673 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6674 \noalign{\hrule}
6675 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6676 &highest&&&&&\cr
6677 % '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
6678 &1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
6679 &2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6680 &3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6681 &4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6682 &5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6683 &6&&left&&\&&\cr
6684 &7&&left&&|&\cr
6685 &8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6686 &9&&left&&||&\cr
6687 &10&&right&&? :&\cr
6688 &11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6689 &lowest&&&&&\cr
6690 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6691 \hrule}
6692 @end tex
6693 @iftex
6694 {
6695 @obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6696 @dag@quad Prefix operators.
6697 @ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6698 }
6699 @end iftex
6700 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6701
6702 @node Evaluation
6703 @subsection Evaluation
6704 @cindex lazy evaluation
6705 @cindex expression evaluation order
6706 The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6707 an expression when absolutely necessary.
6708
6709 The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6710 address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6711 regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6712 as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6713
6714 However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6715 until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6716 other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6717 for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6718
6719 The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6720 assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6721 allocation.
6722
6723 Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6724 @samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6725
6726 If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6727 available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6728 following
6729 @smallexample
6730 @group
6731 SECTIONS
6732 @{
6733 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
6734 @{ *(.text) @}
6735 @}
6736 @end group
6737 @end smallexample
6738 @noindent
6739 will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6740 address}.
6741
6742 @node Expression Section
6743 @subsection The Section of an Expression
6744 @cindex expression sections
6745 @cindex absolute expressions
6746 @cindex relative expressions
6747 @cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6748 @cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6749 @cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
6750 Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6751 relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6752 using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6753 value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6754 symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6755 operations.
6756
6757 Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6758 section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6759 address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6760 @code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6761 functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
6762 One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6763 (@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
6764 differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6765 versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6766 section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6767 Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
6768 absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6769 given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6770 everywhere.
6771
6772 In the following simple example,
6773
6774 @smallexample
6775 @group
6776 SECTIONS
6777 @{
6778 . = 0x100;
6779 __executable_start = 0x100;
6780 .data :
6781 @{
6782 . = 0x10;
6783 __data_start = 0x10;
6784 *(.data)
6785 @}
6786 @dots{}
6787 @}
6788 @end group
6789 @end smallexample
6790
6791 both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6792 address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6793 @code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6794 section in the second two assignments.
6795
6796 For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6797 addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
6798
6799 @itemize @bullet
6800 @item
6801 Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6802 operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6803 absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6804 @item
6805 Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6806 relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6807 and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6808 @item
6809 Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6810 in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6811 address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6812 before applying the operator.
6813 @end itemize
6814
6815 The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6816
6817 @itemize @bullet
6818 @item
6819 An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6820 @item
6821 The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6822 @item
6823 The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
6824 relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
6825 (after above conversions) is also a number when
6826 @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6827 but an absolute address otherwise.
6828 @item
6829 The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6830 relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6831 section as the relative operand(s).
6832 @item
6833 The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6834 conversions) is an absolute address.
6835 @end itemize
6836
6837 You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6838 to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6839 create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6840 section @samp{.data}:
6841 @smallexample
6842 SECTIONS
6843 @{
6844 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6845 @}
6846 @end smallexample
6847 @noindent
6848 If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6849 @samp{.data} section.
6850
6851 Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6852 particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6853
6854 @node Builtin Functions
6855 @subsection Builtin Functions
6856 @cindex functions in expressions
6857 The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6858 use in linker script expressions.
6859
6860 @table @code
6861 @item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6862 @kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6863 @cindex expression, absolute
6864 Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6865 of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6866 value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6867 normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6868
6869 @item ADDR(@var{section})
6870 @kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6871 @cindex section address in expression
6872 Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
6873 script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
6874 the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6875 @code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6876 @code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6877 the other two will be absolute:
6878 @smallexample
6879 @group
6880 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6881 .output1 :
6882 @{
6883 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6884 @dots{}
6885 @}
6886 .output :
6887 @{
6888 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6889 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6890 @}
6891 @dots{} @}
6892 @end group
6893 @end smallexample
6894
6895 @item ALIGN(@var{align})
6896 @itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6897 @kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6898 @kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6899 @cindex round up location counter
6900 @cindex align location counter
6901 @cindex round up expression
6902 @cindex align expression
6903 Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6904 to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6905 doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6906 arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6907 expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
6908 equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
6909
6910 Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6911 next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6912 variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6913 input sections:
6914 @smallexample
6915 @group
6916 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6917 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6918 *(.data)
6919 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6920 @}
6921 @dots{} @}
6922 @end group
6923 @end smallexample
6924 @noindent
6925 The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6926 a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6927 a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6928 of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6929
6930 The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6931
6932 @item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6933 @kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6934 @cindex section alignment
6935 Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6936 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6937 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6938 the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6939 value in that section.
6940 @smallexample
6941 @group
6942 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6943 .output @{
6944 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6945 @dots{}
6946 @}
6947 @dots{} @}
6948 @end group
6949 @end smallexample
6950
6951 @item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6952 @kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6953 This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6954 scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6955 section.
6956
6957 @item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6958 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6959 This is equivalent to either
6960 @smallexample
6961 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6962 @end smallexample
6963 or
6964 @smallexample
6965 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6966 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
6967 @end smallexample
6968 @noindent
6969 depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6970 for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6971 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6972 If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6973 memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6974 bytes in the on-disk file.
6975
6976 This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6977 any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6978 @var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
6979 be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6980 running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6981 that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6982 page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
6983
6984 @noindent
6985 Example:
6986 @smallexample
6987 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6988 @end smallexample
6989
6990 @item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6991 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6992 This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6993 evaluation purposes.
6994
6995 @smallexample
6996 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6997 @end smallexample
6998
6999 @item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7000 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7001 This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
7002 @samp{-z relro} option is used.
7003 When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
7004 does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
7005 @var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
7006 argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
7007 script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
7008 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
7009 padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
7010 section alignment.
7011
7012 @smallexample
7013 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
7014 @end smallexample
7015
7016 @item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7017 @kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7018 @cindex symbol defaults
7019 Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
7020 defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
7021 return 0. You can use this function to provide
7022 default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
7023 shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
7024 the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
7025 existed, its value is preserved:
7026
7027 @smallexample
7028 @group
7029 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7030 .text : @{
7031 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
7032 @dots{}
7033 @}
7034 @dots{}
7035 @}
7036 @end group
7037 @end smallexample
7038
7039 @item LENGTH(@var{memory})
7040 @kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
7041 Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7042
7043 @item LOADADDR(@var{section})
7044 @kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
7045 @cindex section load address in expression
7046 Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
7047 Section LMA}).
7048
7049 @item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7050 @kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7051 Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
7052 @code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7053
7054 @kindex MAX
7055 @item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7056 Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7057
7058 @kindex MIN
7059 @item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7060 Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7061
7062 @item NEXT(@var{exp})
7063 @kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7064 @cindex unallocated address, next
7065 Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7066 This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7067 use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7068 output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7069
7070 @item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7071 @kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7072 Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7073
7074 @item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7075 @kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7076 Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
7077 value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7078 @samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7079 will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7080 can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7081 ``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
7082 name.
7083
7084 @item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7085 @kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7086 @cindex section size
7087 Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7088 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
7089 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
7090 @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
7091 @smallexample
7092 @group
7093 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7094 .output @{
7095 .start = . ;
7096 @dots{}
7097 .end = . ;
7098 @}
7099 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7100 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7101 @dots{} @}
7102 @end group
7103 @end smallexample
7104
7105 @item SIZEOF_HEADERS
7106 @kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7107 @cindex header size
7108 Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7109 information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7110 this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7111 choose, to facilitate paging.
7112
7113 @cindex not enough room for program headers
7114 @cindex program headers, not enough room
7115 When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7116 @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7117 number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7118 addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7119 additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7120 room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7121 the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7122 script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7123 you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7124 command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7125 @end table
7126
7127 @node Implicit Linker Scripts
7128 @section Implicit Linker Scripts
7129 @cindex implicit linker scripts
7130 If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7131 an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7132 linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7133 linker will report an error.
7134
7135 An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7136
7137 Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7138 assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7139 commands.
7140
7141 Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7142 at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7143 read. This can affect archive searching.
7144
7145 @node Plugins
7146 @chapter Linker Plugins
7147
7148 @cindex plugins
7149 @cindex linker plugins
7150 The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7151 For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7152 support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7153
7154 Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7155 be added here later.
7156
7157 @menu
7158 * libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7159 @end menu
7160
7161 @node libdep Plugin
7162 @section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7163 @cindex static library dependencies
7164 Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7165 just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7166 optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7167 within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7168 rose to ascendance.
7169
7170 One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7171 multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7172 dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7173 library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7174 referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7175 link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7176 libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7177 explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7178
7179 The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7180 to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7181 plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7182 dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7183 and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7184 command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7185 utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7186 being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7187 archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7188
7189 For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7190 library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7191 the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7192
7193 @smallexample
7194 -L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7195 @end smallexample
7196
7197 @ifset GENERIC
7198 @node Machine Dependent
7199 @chapter Machine Dependent Features
7200
7201 @cindex machine dependencies
7202 @command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7203 sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
7204 functionality are not listed.
7205
7206 @menu
7207 @ifset H8300
7208 * H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7209 @end ifset
7210 @ifset M68HC11
7211 * M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7212 @end ifset
7213 @ifset ARM
7214 * ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7215 @end ifset
7216 @ifset HPPA
7217 * HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7218 @end ifset
7219 @ifset M68K
7220 * M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7221 @end ifset
7222 @ifset MIPS
7223 * MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7224 @end ifset
7225 @ifset MMIX
7226 * MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
7227 @end ifset
7228 @ifset MSP430
7229 * MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
7230 @end ifset
7231 @ifset NDS32
7232 * NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7233 @end ifset
7234 @ifset NIOSII
7235 * Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7236 @end ifset
7237 @ifset POWERPC
7238 * PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7239 @end ifset
7240 @ifset POWERPC64
7241 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7242 @end ifset
7243 @ifset S/390
7244 * S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7245 @end ifset
7246 @ifset SPU
7247 * SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7248 @end ifset
7249 @ifset TICOFF
7250 * TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
7251 @end ifset
7252 @ifset WIN32
7253 * WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7254 @end ifset
7255 @ifset XTENSA
7256 * Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7257 @end ifset
7258 @end menu
7259 @end ifset
7260
7261 @ifset H8300
7262 @ifclear GENERIC
7263 @raisesections
7264 @end ifclear
7265
7266 @node H8/300
7267 @section @command{ld} and the H8/300
7268
7269 @cindex H8/300 support
7270 For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
7271 you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7272
7273 @table @emph
7274 @cindex relaxing on H8/300
7275 @item relaxing address modes
7276 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7277 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7278 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7279 respectively.
7280
7281 @cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7282 @item synthesizing instructions
7283 @c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
7284 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
7285 sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7286 page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7287 (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7288 @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7289 top page of memory).
7290
7291 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7292 indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7293 displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7294 the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7295 @code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7296 whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7297 range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7298
7299 @item bit manipulation instructions
7300 @command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
7301 biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
7302 which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7303 page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7304 (That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
7305 @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7306 the top page of memory).
7307
7308 @item system control instructions
7309 @command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
7310 32 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
7311 changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7312 (That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
7313 @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7314 the top page of memory).
7315 @end table
7316
7317 @ifclear GENERIC
7318 @lowersections
7319 @end ifclear
7320 @end ifset
7321
7322 @ifclear GENERIC
7323 @ifset Renesas
7324 @c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
7325 @c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7326 @node Renesas
7327 @chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
7328
7329 @command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7330 H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7331 options are required for these chips.
7332 @end ifset
7333 @end ifclear
7334
7335 @ifset ARM
7336 @ifclear GENERIC
7337 @raisesections
7338 @end ifclear
7339
7340 @ifset M68HC11
7341 @ifclear GENERIC
7342 @raisesections
7343 @end ifclear
7344
7345 @node M68HC11/68HC12
7346 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7347
7348 @cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7349
7350 @subsection Linker Relaxation
7351
7352 For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7353 optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7354
7355 @table @emph
7356 @cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7357 @item relaxing address modes
7358 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7359 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7360 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7361 respectively.
7362
7363 @command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7364 transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7365 page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7366
7367 @item relaxing gcc instruction group
7368 When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7369 of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7370 addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7371 @code{bset} instructions.
7372
7373 @end table
7374
7375 @subsection Trampoline Generation
7376
7377 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7378 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7379 For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7380 call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
7381 will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
7382 trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7383 case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7384 point to the function trampoline.
7385
7386 @ifclear GENERIC
7387 @lowersections
7388 @end ifclear
7389 @end ifset
7390
7391 @node ARM
7392 @section @command{ld} and the ARM family
7393
7394 @cindex ARM interworking support
7395 @kindex --support-old-code
7396 For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
7397 between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
7398 been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7399 line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7400 libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
7401 option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
7402 given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7403 which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7404 the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7405 non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7406
7407 @cindex thumb entry point
7408 @cindex entry point, thumb
7409 @kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7410 The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7411 @samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7412 But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7413 branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7414 executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7415
7416 @cindex PE import table prefixing
7417 @kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7418 The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7419 the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
7420 element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
7421 import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7422
7423 @cindex BE8
7424 @kindex --be8
7425 The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
7426 executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7427 objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7428 option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7429 little-endian code.
7430
7431 @cindex TARGET1
7432 @kindex --target1-rel
7433 @kindex --target1-abs
7434 The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7435 @samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7436 or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7437 and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7438
7439 @cindex TARGET2
7440 @kindex --target2=@var{type}
7441 The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7442 @samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7443 meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7444 @table @samp
7445 @item rel
7446 @samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7447 @item abs
7448 @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
7449 @item got-rel
7450 @samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7451 @end table
7452
7453 @cindex FIX_V4BX
7454 @kindex --fix-v4bx
7455 The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7456 specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7457 interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7458 also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7459
7460 In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7461 linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7462 @code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7463
7464 In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7465 relocations are ignored.
7466
7467 @cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7468 @kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7469 Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7470 relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7471
7472 @smallexample
7473 TST rM, #1
7474 MOVEQ PC, rM
7475 BX Rn
7476 @end smallexample
7477
7478 This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7479 and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
7480 condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
7481
7482 @cindex USE_BLX
7483 @kindex --use-blx
7484 The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7485 BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7486 situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7487 code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7488 each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7489
7490 @cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7491 @kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7492 The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7493 bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7494 instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7495 to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7496 the support code can read the intended values.
7497
7498 The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7499 intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7500 and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7501 intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7502 full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7503 you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7504
7505 If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7506 enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7507 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7508 mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7509 vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7510 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7511
7512 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7513 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7514 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7515 first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7516 instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7517 the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7518 are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7519
7520 @cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7521 @kindex --fix-arm1176
7522 @kindex --no-fix-arm1176
7523 The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7524 in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7525 are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
7526 unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7527
7528 Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
7529 Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
7530 http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7531
7532 @cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7533 @kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7534
7535 The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7536 workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7537 the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7538 off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7539 the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7540 core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7541 integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7542 VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7543
7544 The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7545 necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7546
7547 The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7548 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7549 STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7550 linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7551 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7552
7553 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7554 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7555 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7556 replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7557 branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7558 then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7559
7560 The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7561 the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7562
7563 The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7564 they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7565 there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7566 occurs.
7567
7568 The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7569 PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7570 large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7571 cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7572 occurs.
7573
7574 @cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7575 @kindex --no-enum-size-warning
7576 The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7577 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7578 enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7579 linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7580 using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7581 not be diagnosed.
7582
7583 @cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7584 @kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7585 The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7586 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7587 @code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7588 linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7589 using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
7590
7591 @cindex PIC_VENEER
7592 @kindex --pic-veneer
7593 The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7594 ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7595 is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7596 @samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7597
7598 @cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7599 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7600 The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7601 code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7602 perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7603 placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
7604 controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
7605 The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
7606 duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
7607 group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7608 code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7609 where they should be placed.
7610
7611 The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7612 @option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
7613 placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
7614 branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7615 placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7616 value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7617 exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7618 A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7619 linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7620 from the input sections.
7621
7622 The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7623 @samp{N = +1}.
7624
7625 Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7626 only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7627 otherwise.
7628
7629 @cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7630 @kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7631 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7632 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7633
7634 The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7635
7636 @cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7637 @kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7638 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7639 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7640
7641 Please contact ARM for further details.
7642
7643 @kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7644 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7645 @cindex Merging exidx entries
7646 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7647
7648 @kindex --long-plt
7649 @cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7650 The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7651 which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7652 entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7653
7654 @kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7655 @cindex AArch64 rela addend
7656 The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7657 link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7658
7659 @cindex Placement of SG veneers
7660 All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
7661 Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
7662 @samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7663 veneers in memory.
7664
7665 @kindex --cmse-implib
7666 @cindex Secure gateway import library
7667 The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7668 specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7669 secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7670 executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7671
7672 @kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7673 @cindex Input import library
7674 The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7675 must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7676 given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7677 in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7678 @samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7679 library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7680 library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7681 for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7682 specified.
7683
7684 @ifclear GENERIC
7685 @lowersections
7686 @end ifclear
7687 @end ifset
7688
7689 @ifset HPPA
7690 @ifclear GENERIC
7691 @raisesections
7692 @end ifclear
7693
7694 @node HPPA ELF32
7695 @section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7696 @cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7697 @kindex --multi-subspace
7698 When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7699 import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7700 The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7701 stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7702 multiple sub-spaces.
7703
7704 @cindex HPPA stub grouping
7705 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7706 Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7707 stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7708 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7709 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7710 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7711 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7712 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7713 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7714 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7715 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7716 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7717 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7718 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7719 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7720
7721 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7722 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7723 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7724 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7725
7726 @ifclear GENERIC
7727 @lowersections
7728 @end ifclear
7729 @end ifset
7730
7731 @ifset M68K
7732 @ifclear GENERIC
7733 @raisesections
7734 @end ifclear
7735
7736 @node M68K
7737 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7738
7739 @cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7740 @kindex --got=@var{type}
7741 The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7742 The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7743 @samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7744 the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7745 @samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7746 entries only at non-negative offsets.
7747 @samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7748 entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7749 support such GOTs.
7750 @samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7751 output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7752 file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7753 files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7754
7755 @ifclear GENERIC
7756 @lowersections
7757 @end ifclear
7758 @end ifset
7759
7760 @ifset MIPS
7761 @ifclear GENERIC
7762 @raisesections
7763 @end ifclear
7764
7765 @node MIPS
7766 @section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7767
7768 @cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7769 @kindex --insn32
7770 @kindex --no-insn32
7771 The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7772 microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7773 in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7774 used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7775 or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7776 including 16-bit ones where possible.
7777
7778 @cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7779 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7780 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7781 The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7782 control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7783 @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7784 relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7785 calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7786 relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7787 instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7788 or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7789 the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7790
7791 @ifclear GENERIC
7792 @lowersections
7793 @end ifclear
7794 @end ifset
7795
7796 @ifset MMIX
7797 @ifclear GENERIC
7798 @raisesections
7799 @end ifclear
7800
7801 @node MMIX
7802 @section @code{ld} and MMIX
7803 For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7804 @code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7805 understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7806 can translate between the two formats.
7807
7808 There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7809 Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7810 registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7811 equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7812 @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7813 global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7814 this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7815 symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7816
7817 Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7818 @code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7819 The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7820 of a section.
7821
7822 Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7823 are left out from an mmo file.
7824
7825 @ifclear GENERIC
7826 @lowersections
7827 @end ifclear
7828 @end ifset
7829
7830 @ifset MSP430
7831 @ifclear GENERIC
7832 @raisesections
7833 @end ifclear
7834
7835 @node MSP430
7836 @section @code{ld} and MSP430
7837 For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7838 will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7839 just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7840
7841 @cindex MSP430 extra sections
7842 The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7843
7844 @table @code
7845 @item @samp{.vectors}
7846 Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7847
7848 @item @samp{.bootloader}
7849 Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7850 in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7851
7852 @item @samp{.infomem}
7853 Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7854 this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7855
7856 @item @samp{.infomemnobits}
7857 This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7858 in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7859
7860 @item @samp{.noinit}
7861 Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7862
7863 The last two sections are used by gcc.
7864 @end table
7865
7866 @table @option
7867 @cindex MSP430 Options
7868 @kindex --code-region
7869 @item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7870 This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7871 argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7872 using this option.
7873
7874 @kindex --data-region
7875 @item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7876 This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7877 [either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7878 for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7879
7880 @kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7881 @item --disable-sec-transformation
7882 Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7883 and @code{--data-region} options.
7884 This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7885 wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7886 not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7887 @end table
7888
7889 @ifclear GENERIC
7890 @lowersections
7891 @end ifclear
7892 @end ifset
7893
7894 @ifset NDS32
7895 @ifclear GENERIC
7896 @raisesections
7897 @end ifclear
7898
7899 @node NDS32
7900 @section @code{ld} and NDS32
7901 @kindex relaxing on NDS32
7902 For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7903 relaxes objects according to these options.
7904
7905 @table @code
7906 @item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7907 Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7908
7909 @item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7910 Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7911
7912 @item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7913 Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7914
7915 @item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7916 Export the EX9 table after linking.
7917
7918 @item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7919 Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7920
7921 @item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7922 Update the existing EX9 table.
7923
7924 @item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7925 Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7926
7927 @item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7928 Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7929
7930 @item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7931 Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7932
7933 @item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7934 Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7935 @end table
7936
7937 @ifclear GENERIC
7938 @lowersections
7939 @end ifclear
7940 @end ifset
7941
7942 @ifset NIOSII
7943 @ifclear GENERIC
7944 @raisesections
7945 @end ifclear
7946
7947 @node Nios II
7948 @section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7949 @cindex Nios II call relaxation
7950 @kindex --relax on Nios II
7951
7952 Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7953 transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7954 which may result in @command{ld} giving
7955 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7956 The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7957 trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7958 outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7959 trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7960 be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7961 larger than 256MB.
7962
7963 The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7964 is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7965 @option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7966 locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7967 source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7968 register as a temporary.
7969
7970 Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7971 relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7972 option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7973
7974 @ifclear GENERIC
7975 @lowersections
7976 @end ifclear
7977 @end ifset
7978
7979 @ifset POWERPC
7980 @ifclear GENERIC
7981 @raisesections
7982 @end ifclear
7983
7984 @node PowerPC ELF32
7985 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7986 @cindex PowerPC long branches
7987 @kindex --relax on PowerPC
7988 Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7989 displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7990 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7991 @samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7992 the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7993 section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
7994 section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7995 @samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7996 both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7997 considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
7998
7999 @cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
8000 @table @option
8001 @cindex PowerPC PLT
8002 @kindex --bss-plt
8003 @item --bss-plt
8004 Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
8005 generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
8006 the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
8007 writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
8008 @command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
8009 PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
8010 compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
8011 BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
8012
8013 @kindex --secure-plt
8014 @item --secure-plt
8015 @command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
8016 @samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
8017 when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
8018 layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
8019 style BSS PLT.
8020
8021 @cindex PowerPC GOT
8022 @kindex --sdata-got
8023 @item --sdata-got
8024 The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
8025 sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
8026 @code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
8027 section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
8028 @code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
8029 @code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
8030 @samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
8031 @code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
8032 PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
8033 pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
8034 GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
8035 really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
8036
8037 @cindex PowerPC stub symbols
8038 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8039 @item --emit-stub-syms
8040 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8041 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8042
8043 @cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
8044 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8045 @item --no-tls-optimize
8046 PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8047 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8048 disable the optimization.
8049 @end table
8050
8051 @ifclear GENERIC
8052 @lowersections
8053 @end ifclear
8054 @end ifset
8055
8056 @ifset POWERPC64
8057 @ifclear GENERIC
8058 @raisesections
8059 @end ifclear
8060
8061 @node PowerPC64 ELF64
8062 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8063
8064 @cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8065 @table @option
8066 @cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8067 @kindex --stub-group-size
8068 @item --stub-group-size
8069 Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8070 by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8071 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8072 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8073 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8074 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8075 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8076 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8077 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8078 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8079 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8080 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8081 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8082 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8083
8084 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8085 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8086 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8087 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8088
8089 @cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8090 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8091 @item --emit-stub-syms
8092 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8093 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8094
8095 @cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8096 @kindex --dotsyms
8097 @kindex --no-dotsyms
8098 @item --dotsyms
8099 @itemx --no-dotsyms
8100 These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8101 in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8102 function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8103 code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8104 properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8105 to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8106 @samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8107 dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8108 feature.
8109
8110 @cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8111 @kindex --save-restore-funcs
8112 @kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
8113 @item --save-restore-funcs
8114 @itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
8115 These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8116 provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8117 @samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8118 function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8119 link.
8120
8121 @cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8122 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
8123 @item --no-tls-optimize
8124 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8125 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8126 disable the optimization.
8127
8128 @cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8129 @kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8130 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8131 @kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8132 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
8133 @item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8134 @itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
8135 These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
8136 stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8137 an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8138 @code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
8139 stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8140 generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8141 __tls_get_addr_opt.
8142 Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8143 much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8144 an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8145 will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8146 @option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8147 and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8148 this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8149 Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
8150 @option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
8151 register saves.
8152
8153 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8154 @kindex --no-opd-optimize
8155 @item --no-opd-optimize
8156 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8157 corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
8158 the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
8159 Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8160
8161 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8162 @kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8163 @item --non-overlapping-opd
8164 Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8165 @code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8166 the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8167 entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8168
8169 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8170 @kindex --no-toc-optimize
8171 @item --no-toc-optimize
8172 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8173 entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8174 reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8175 marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8176 marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8177 relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8178 unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8179 reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8180 discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8181 reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8182 code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8183 optimization.
8184
8185 @cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8186 @kindex --no-inline-optimize
8187 @item --no-inline-optimize
8188 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8189 marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8190 @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8191 a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8192 locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8193 disables that optimization.
8194
8195 @cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8196 @kindex --no-multi-toc
8197 @item --no-multi-toc
8198 If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8199 @code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8200 where TOC
8201 entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8202 total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8203 grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8204 TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8205 calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8206 help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
8207 64K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8208 Use this option to turn off this feature.
8209
8210 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8211 @kindex --no-toc-sort
8212 @item --no-toc-sort
8213 By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8214 happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8215 placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8216 with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8217 referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8218 @code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8219 results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8220 off this feature.
8221
8222 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8223 @kindex --plt-align
8224 @kindex --no-plt-align
8225 @item --plt-align
8226 @itemx --no-plt-align
8227 Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
8228 aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8229 boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8230 specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8231 specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8232 if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8233 PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
8234
8235 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8236 @kindex --plt-static-chain
8237 @kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8238 @item --plt-static-chain
8239 @itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8240 Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8241 chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8242 chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8243
8244 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8245 @kindex --plt-thread-safe
8246 @kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8247 @item --plt-thread-safe
8248 @itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
8249 With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8250 lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8251 another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8252 order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8253 memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8254 barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8255 looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8256 seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8257 default behaviour.
8258
8259 @cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8260 @kindex --plt-localentry
8261 @kindex --no-plt-localentry
8262 @item --plt-localentry
8263 @itemx --no-localentry
8264 ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8265 ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8266 (the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8267 Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8268 or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8269 functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8270 in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
8271 interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8272 including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8273 to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8274 complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8275 care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
8276
8277 @cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8278 @kindex --power10-stubs
8279 @kindex --no-power10-stubs
8280 @item --power10-stubs
8281 @itemx --no-power10-stubs
8282 When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8283 relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
8284 linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8285 for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8286 power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
8287 power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8288 allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
8289 @option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8290 auto mode.
8291 @end table
8292
8293 @ifclear GENERIC
8294 @lowersections
8295 @end ifclear
8296 @end ifset
8297
8298 @ifset S/390
8299 @ifclear GENERIC
8300 @raisesections
8301 @end ifclear
8302
8303 @node S/390 ELF
8304 @section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8305
8306 @cindex S/390 ELF options
8307 @table @option
8308
8309 @cindex S/390
8310 @kindex --s390-pgste
8311 @item --s390-pgste
8312 This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8313 segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8314 binaries marked that way.
8315 @end table
8316
8317 @ifclear GENERIC
8318 @lowersections
8319 @end ifclear
8320 @end ifset
8321
8322 @ifset SPU
8323 @ifclear GENERIC
8324 @raisesections
8325 @end ifclear
8326
8327 @node SPU ELF
8328 @section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8329
8330 @cindex SPU ELF options
8331 @table @option
8332
8333 @cindex SPU plugins
8334 @kindex --plugin
8335 @item --plugin
8336 This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8337
8338 @cindex SPU overlays
8339 @kindex --no-overlays
8340 @item --no-overlays
8341 Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8342 regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8343 @command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8344 turns off all this special overlay handling.
8345
8346 @cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8347 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8348 @item --emit-stub-syms
8349 This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8350 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8351
8352 @cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8353 @kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8354 @item --extra-overlay-stubs
8355 This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8356 function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8357 on calls to non-overlay regions.
8358
8359 @cindex SPU local store size
8360 @kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8361 @item --local-store=lo:hi
8362 @command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8363 the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8364 range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8365
8366 @cindex SPU
8367 @kindex --stack-analysis
8368 @item --stack-analysis
8369 SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8370 unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8371 under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8372 @command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8373 @command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8374 determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8375 for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8376 for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8377 for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8378 find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8379 and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8380 under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8381 dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8382 is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8383 and calls will be given.
8384
8385 @cindex SPU
8386 @kindex --emit-stack-syms
8387 @item --emit-stack-syms
8388 This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8389 in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8390 These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8391 functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8392 functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8393 such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8394 The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
8395 @code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
8396 @end table
8397
8398 @ifclear GENERIC
8399 @lowersections
8400 @end ifclear
8401 @end ifset
8402
8403 @ifset TICOFF
8404 @ifclear GENERIC
8405 @raisesections
8406 @end ifclear
8407
8408 @node TI COFF
8409 @section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8410 @cindex TI COFF versions
8411 @kindex --format=@var{version}
8412 The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8413 TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8414 also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8415 format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8416 header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8417
8418 @ifclear GENERIC
8419 @lowersections
8420 @end ifclear
8421 @end ifset
8422
8423 @ifset WIN32
8424 @ifclear GENERIC
8425 @raisesections
8426 @end ifclear
8427
8428 @node WIN32
8429 @section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8430
8431 This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
8432 See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8433 command-line options mentioned here.
8434
8435 @table @emph
8436 @cindex import libraries
8437 @item import libraries
8438 The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
8439 libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
8440 regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8441 archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
8442 support for creating such libraries provided with the
8443 @samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
8444
8445 @item exporting DLL symbols
8446 @cindex exporting DLL symbols
8447 The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8448
8449 @table @emph
8450 @item using auto-export functionality
8451 @cindex using auto-export functionality
8452 By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
8453 which is controlled by the following command-line options:
8454
8455 @itemize
8456 @item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8457 @item --exclude-symbols
8458 @item --exclude-libs
8459 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib
8460 @item --version-script
8461 @end itemize
8462
8463 When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8464 (global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8465 symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8466 often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8467 private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
8468 options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
8469 exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8470 final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8471
8472 If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
8473 command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8474 if either of the following are true:
8475
8476 @itemize
8477 @item A DEF file is used.
8478 @item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8479 @end itemize
8480
8481 @item using a DEF file
8482 @cindex using a DEF file
8483 Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8484 an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8485 exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8486 name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
8487 command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
8488
8489 @example
8490 gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8491 @end example
8492
8493 Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8494 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8495
8496 Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8497
8498 @example
8499 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
8500
8501 EXPORTS
8502 foo
8503 bar
8504 _bar = bar
8505 another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8506 var1 DATA
8507 doo = foo == foo2
8508 eoo DATA == var1
8509 @end example
8510
8511 This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
8512 symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8513 alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8514 by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8515 @code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
8516 @code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8517 export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8518 in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8519 symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
8520
8521 The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8522 name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8523 the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8524
8525 When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8526 library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
8527 @code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
8528 executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
8529
8530 With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8531 specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
8532 non-default base address for the image.
8533
8534 If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
8535 or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8536 filename specified on the command line.
8537
8538 The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8539
8540 @example
8541 EXPORTS
8542 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8543 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
8544 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
8545 @end example
8546
8547 Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8548 @samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8549 @samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8550 @samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8551 Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
8552 @samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8553 string in import/export table for the symbol.
8554
8555 The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8556
8557 @code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8558 will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8559 by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8560 linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8561 library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8562
8563 @code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8564 The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8565 the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8566 @code{*_imp__foo}).
8567
8568 @code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8569 well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8570 read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8571 variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8572 the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8573 extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8574 application will behave unexpectedly.
8575
8576 @code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8577 it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8578 symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
8579 API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
8580 the DLL without an import library.
8581
8582 See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8583 other DEF file statements
8584
8585 @cindex creating a DEF file
8586 While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
8587 with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
8588
8589 @item Using decorations
8590 @cindex Using decorations
8591 Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8592 itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8593 declared as:
8594
8595 @example
8596 __declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8597 __declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8598 @end example
8599
8600 All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8601 any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8602 this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8603 the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8604
8605 Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
8606 decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
8607 instead:
8608
8609 @example
8610 __declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8611 __declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8612 @end example
8613
8614 This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8615 when included by the library itself the header must declare the
8616 variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8617 code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
8618 of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
8619 omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8620 @samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
8621 information.
8622 @end table
8623
8624 @cindex automatic data imports
8625 @item automatic data imports
8626 The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
8627 by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
8628 compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
8629 issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
8630 code to these platforms, especially for large
8631 c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
8632 initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
8633 decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
8634 platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
8635 command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8636 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8637 suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8638 trigger the feature's use.
8639
8640 auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
8641 additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8642
8643 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
8644 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8645
8646 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8647 occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8648 One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
8649 below.
8650
8651 @cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
8652 For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8653 object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8654 offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8655 field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8656 in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
8657 without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
8658 The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
8659 references.
8660
8661 The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8662 be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8663 themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8664 runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8665 compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8666 support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
8667 run without error on an older system.
8668
8669 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8670 enabled as needed.
8671
8672 @cindex direct linking to a dll
8673 @item direct linking to a dll
8674 The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8675 including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
8676 libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
8677 traditional import library method, especially when linking large
8678 libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8679 function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8680 though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
8681 storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
8682 tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
8683 large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8684
8685 Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
8686 @samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
8687 of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
8688 perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8689 select the dll instead of an import library.
8690
8691
8692 For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8693 to find, in the first directory of its search path,
8694
8695 @example
8696 libxxx.dll.a
8697 xxx.dll.a
8698 libxxx.a
8699 xxx.lib
8700 libxxx.lib
8701 cygxxx.dll (*)
8702 libxxx.dll
8703 xxx.dll
8704 @end example
8705
8706 before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8707
8708 (*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8709 where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8710 @samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8711 file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
8712 @samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8713
8714 Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8715 @samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
8716 was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8717 various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8718 could coexist on the same machine.
8719
8720 The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8721 applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
8722 libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
8723
8724 @example
8725 bin/
8726 cygxxx.dll
8727 lib/
8728 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
8729 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
8730 @end example
8731
8732 Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8733 done two ways:
8734
8735 1. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8736 @example
8737 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
8738 @end example
8739
8740 However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8741 (@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8742 @samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8743 not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8744
8745 2. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8746 directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8747 should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8748 making the app/dll.
8749
8750 @example
8751 ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
8752 @end example
8753
8754 Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8755
8756 @example
8757 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
8758 @end example
8759
8760 This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8761 perfectly legal
8762
8763 @example
8764 bin/
8765 cygxxx-5.dll
8766 lib/
8767 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
8768 @end example
8769
8770 Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
8771 even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8772 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8773
8774 Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
8775 wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
8776
8777 1. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8778 work with auto-imported data.
8779
8780 2. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8781 import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8782 symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8783 for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8784 possible to do this without an import lib.
8785
8786 3. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8787 critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8788 in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8789 stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8790
8791 So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
8792 true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8793 a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8794 binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
8795 massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8796 requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8797 will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
8798
8799 @item symbol aliasing
8800 @table @emph
8801 @item adding additional names
8802 Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
8803 A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8804 exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8805 when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
8806 import library. Consider the following DEF file:
8807
8808 @example
8809 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8810
8811 EXPORTS
8812 foo
8813 _foo = foo
8814 @end example
8815
8816 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8817
8818 Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8819 source code using the "weak" attribute:
8820
8821 @example
8822 void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
8823 void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
8824 @end example
8825
8826 See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8827 symbols.
8828
8829 @item renaming symbols
8830 Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
8831 kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
8832 @samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8833 DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
8834 created). In the following example:
8835
8836 @example
8837 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8838
8839 EXPORTS
8840 _foo = foo
8841 @end example
8842
8843 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8844 @samp{_foo}.
8845 @end table
8846
8847 Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
8848 unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
8849 If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
8850 @emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8851 that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8852 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8853 renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8854 to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8855 the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8856 In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
8857 which is probably not what you wanted.
8858
8859 @cindex weak externals
8860 @item weak externals
8861 The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8862 weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8863 defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8864 are three variants of weak externals:
8865 @itemize
8866 @item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8867 called lazy externals.
8868 @item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8869 This form is not presently implemented.
8870 @item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8871 implemented.
8872 @end itemize
8873 As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8874 are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8875 uses a default value.
8876
8877 @cindex aligned common symbols
8878 @item aligned common symbols
8879 As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8880 desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8881 the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8882 carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8883 by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8884 tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8885 but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8886 warnings about unknown linker directives.
8887
8888 @end table
8889
8890 @ifclear GENERIC
8891 @lowersections
8892 @end ifclear
8893 @end ifset
8894
8895 @ifset XTENSA
8896 @ifclear GENERIC
8897 @raisesections
8898 @end ifclear
8899
8900 @node Xtensa
8901 @section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8902
8903 @cindex Xtensa processors
8904 The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8905 @code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8906 specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8907 keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8908 example, with the command:
8909
8910 @smallexample
8911 SECTIONS
8912 @{
8913 .text : @{
8914 *(.literal .text)
8915 @}
8916 @}
8917 @end smallexample
8918
8919 @noindent
8920 @command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8921 and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8922 literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8923 interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8924 group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8925 files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8926 and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
8927
8928 @cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
8929 @cindex relaxing on Xtensa
8930 Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8931 provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8932 is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8933 literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8934 will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8935 location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8936 the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8937 unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8938 @code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8939 range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8940
8941 For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8942 to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8943 instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8944 instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8945 instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8946 @code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8947 hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8948 By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8949 switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8950 density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8951 instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8952 performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8953 linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8954 a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8955
8956 The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8957 control the linker:
8958
8959 @cindex Xtensa options
8960 @table @option
8961 @item --size-opt
8962 When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8963 more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8964 no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8965 alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8966 preserve the correctness of the code.
8967
8968 @item --abi-windowed
8969 @itemx --abi-call0
8970 Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8971 PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8972 because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8973 conventions.
8974 Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8975 of the first input object.
8976 A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8977 or the chosen output object ABI.
8978 @end table
8979
8980 @ifclear GENERIC
8981 @lowersections
8982 @end ifclear
8983 @end ifset
8984
8985 @ifclear SingleFormat
8986 @node BFD
8987 @chapter BFD
8988
8989 @cindex back end
8990 @cindex object file management
8991 @cindex object formats available
8992 @kindex objdump -i
8993 The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8994 These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8995 object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8996 format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8997 it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8998 associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8999 object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
9000 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
9001 list all the formats available for your configuration.
9002
9003 @cindex BFD requirements
9004 @cindex requirements for BFD
9005 As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
9006 several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
9007 BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
9008 formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
9009 been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
9010 BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
9011 may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
9012
9013 One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
9014 mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
9015 useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
9016 conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
9017
9018 @menu
9019 * BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
9020 @end menu
9021
9022 @node BFD outline
9023 @section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
9024 @cindex opening object files
9025 @include bfdsumm.texi
9026 @end ifclear
9027
9028 @node Reporting Bugs
9029 @chapter Reporting Bugs
9030 @cindex bugs in @command{ld}
9031 @cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
9032
9033 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
9034
9035 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
9036 it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
9037 to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
9038 work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
9039 @command{ld}.
9040
9041 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
9042 information that enables us to fix the bug.
9043
9044 @menu
9045 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
9046 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
9047 @end menu
9048
9049 @node Bug Criteria
9050 @section Have You Found a Bug?
9051 @cindex bug criteria
9052
9053 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9054
9055 @itemize @bullet
9056 @cindex fatal signal
9057 @cindex linker crash
9058 @cindex crash of linker
9059 @item
9060 If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
9061 @command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
9062
9063 @cindex error on valid input
9064 @item
9065 If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
9066
9067 @cindex invalid input
9068 @item
9069 If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
9070 may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9071 object files are correct.
9072
9073 @item
9074 If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
9075 improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
9076 @end itemize
9077
9078 @node Bug Reporting
9079 @section How to Report Bugs
9080 @cindex bug reports
9081 @cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
9082
9083 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
9084 products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
9085 recommend you contact that organization first.
9086
9087 You can find contact information for many support companies and
9088 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9089 distribution.
9090
9091 @ifset BUGURL
9092 Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
9093 @value{BUGURL}.
9094 @end ifset
9095
9096 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9097 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9098 fact or leave it out, state it!
9099
9100 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9101 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
9102 assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9103 matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9104 the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9105 location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9106 were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9107 into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9108 specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
9109 and the most helpful.
9110
9111 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9112 the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9113 on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
9114
9115 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
9116 bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9117 respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9118 You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
9119
9120 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9121
9122 @itemize @bullet
9123 @item
9124 The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
9125 the @samp{--version} argument.
9126
9127 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
9128 the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
9129
9130 @item
9131 Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
9132 patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9133
9134 @item
9135 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9136 version number.
9137
9138 @item
9139 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
9140 ``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9141
9142 @item
9143 The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9144 observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9145 list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9146 sufficient.
9147
9148 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9149 and then we might not encounter the bug.
9150
9151 @item
9152 A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
9153 bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9154 provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9155 bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9156 state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9157 requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9158 we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9159 attachments are best.
9160
9161 If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9162 @code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9163 object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9164 @code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9165 how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9166
9167 @item
9168 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9169 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9170
9171 Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
9172 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9173 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9174 a chance to make a mistake.
9175
9176 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9177 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
9178 copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
9179 C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9180 and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9181 fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9182 you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9183 any conclusion from our observations.
9184
9185 @item
9186 If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
9187 diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9188 @samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
9189 If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
9190 context, not by line number.
9191
9192 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9193 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9194 @end itemize
9195
9196 Here are some things that are not necessary:
9197
9198 @itemize @bullet
9199 @item
9200 A description of the envelope of the bug.
9201
9202 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9203 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9204 changes will not affect it.
9205
9206 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9207 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9208 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9209 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9210
9211 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9212 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9213 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9214 less time, and so on.
9215
9216 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9217 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9218
9219 @item
9220 A patch for the bug.
9221
9222 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9223 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9224 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9225 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9226
9227 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
9228 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9229 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9230 able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9231 fixed.
9232
9233 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9234 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9235 help us to understand.
9236
9237 @item
9238 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9239
9240 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9241 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9242 @end itemize
9243
9244 @node MRI
9245 @appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9246 @cindex MRI compatibility
9247 To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9248 linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
9249 alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9250 described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9251 simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
9252 @command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
9253 linker commands; these commands are described here.
9254
9255 In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9256 file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9257 features to make use of them.
9258
9259 You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9260 @samp{-c} command-line option.
9261
9262 Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9263 command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9264 blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
9265 MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
9266 issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9267
9268 Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9269
9270 You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9271 lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9272 The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9273
9274 @table @code
9275 @cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9276 @item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9277 @itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9278 Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
9279 the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9280 @code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9281 your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9282 script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9283 commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9284 input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9285 @code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9286
9287 @cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9288 @item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9289 Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9290 in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9291
9292 @var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9293
9294 @cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9295 @item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9296 Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9297 @var{expression} should be a power of two.
9298
9299 @cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9300 @item BASE @var{expression}
9301 Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9302 absolute addresses) in the output file.
9303
9304 @cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9305 @item CHIP @var{expression}
9306 @itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9307 This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9308
9309 @cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9310 @item END
9311 This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9312
9313 @cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9314 @item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9315 Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
9316 language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
9317
9318 @cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9319 @item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9320 Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
9321 @command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
9322
9323 The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9324 same line, with no change in its effect.
9325
9326 @cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9327 @item LOAD @var{filename}
9328 @itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9329 Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
9330 same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
9331 command line.
9332
9333 @cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9334 @item NAME @var{output-name}
9335 @var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
9336 MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9337 option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9338
9339 @cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9340 @item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9341 @itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
9342 Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
9343 order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9344 script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9345 sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9346 file, in the order specified.
9347
9348 @cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9349 @item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9350 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9351 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9352 Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9353 @var{name} used in the linker input files.
9354
9355 @cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9356 @item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9357 @itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9358 @itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9359 You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9360 specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9361 If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9362 @var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9363 @end table
9364
9365 @node GNU Free Documentation License
9366 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
9367 @include fdl.texi
9368
9369 @node LD Index
9370 @unnumbered LD Index
9371
9372 @printindex cp
9373
9374 @tex
9375 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
9376 % meantime:
9377 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9378 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9379 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9380 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9381 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9382 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9383 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9384 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9385 \page\colophon
9386 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
9387 @end tex
9388
9389 @bye